Fix minor whitespace issues after "." in manual.
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / org.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.2 (GNU Emacs 24.3)
6
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
11
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
18 @c %**end of header
19 @finalout
20
21
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
23
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
26
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
29
30 @set cmdnames
31
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
33
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
45
46 @c a key but no command
47 @c Inserts: @item key
48 @macro orgkey{key}
49 @kindex \key\
50 @item @kbd{\key\}
51 @end macro
52
53 @macro xorgkey{key}
54 @kindex \key\
55 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
56 @end macro
57
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
61 @ifset cmdnames
62 @kindex \key\
63 @findex \command\
64 @iftex
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
66 @end iftex
67 @ifnottex
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
69 @end ifnottex
70 @end ifset
71 @ifclear cmdnames
72 @kindex \key\
73 @item @kbd{\key\}
74 @end ifclear
75 @end macro
76
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
80 @ifset cmdnames
81 @kindex \key\
82 @findex \command\
83 @iftex
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
85 @end iftex
86 @ifnottex
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
88 @end ifnottex
89 @end ifset
90 @ifclear cmdnames
91 @kindex \key\
92 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
93 @end ifclear
94 @end macro
95
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
99 @ifset cmdnames
100 @findex \command\
101 @iftex
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
103 @end iftex
104 @ifnottex
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
106 @end ifnottex
107 @end ifset
108 @ifclear cmdnames
109 @item @kbd{\key\}
110 @end ifclear
111 @end macro
112
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
116 @ifset cmdnames
117 @kindex \key\
118 @findex \command\
119 @iftex
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
121 @end iftex
122 @ifnottex
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
124 @end ifnottex
125 @end ifset
126 @ifclear cmdnames
127 @kindex \key\
128 @item @kbd{\text\}
129 @end ifclear
130 @end macro
131
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
135 @ifset cmdnames
136 @kindex \key1\
137 @kindex \key2\
138 @findex \command\
139 @iftex
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
141 @end iftex
142 @ifnottex
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
144 @end ifnottex
145 @end ifset
146 @ifclear cmdnames
147 @kindex \key1\
148 @kindex \key2\
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
150 @end ifclear
151 @end macro
152
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
154 @c @itemx
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
158 @ifset cmdnames
159 @kindex \key1\
160 @kindex \key2\
161 @findex \command\
162 @iftex
163 @item @kbd{\key1\}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
165 @end iftex
166 @ifnottex
167 @item @kbd{\key1\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
169 @end ifnottex
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear cmdnames
172 @kindex \key1\
173 @kindex \key2\
174 @item @kbd{\key1\}
175 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
176 @end ifclear
177 @end macro
178
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
182 @ifset cmdnames
183 @kindex \key1\
184 @kindex \key2\
185 @findex \command\
186 @iftex
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
188 @end iftex
189 @ifnottex
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
191 @end ifnottex
192 @end ifset
193 @ifclear cmdnames
194 @kindex \key1\
195 @kindex \key2\
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
197 @end ifclear
198 @end macro
199
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
203 @ifset cmdnames
204 @kindex \key1\
205 @kindex \key2\
206 @findex \command\
207 @iftex
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
209 @end iftex
210 @ifnottex
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
212 @end ifnottex
213 @end ifset
214 @ifclear cmdnames
215 @kindex \key1\
216 @kindex \key2\
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
218 @end ifclear
219 @end macro
220
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
225 @ifset cmdnames
226 @kindex \key1\
227 @kindex \key2\
228 @findex \command1\
229 @findex \command2\
230 @iftex
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
233 @end iftex
234 @ifnottex
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
237 @end ifnottex
238 @end ifset
239 @ifclear cmdnames
240 @kindex \key1\
241 @kindex \key2\
242 @item @kbd{\key1\}
243 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
244 @end ifclear
245 @end macro
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
247
248 @iftex
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
250 @end iftex
251
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
254 @ifinfo
255 @subsubheading \text\
256 @end ifinfo
257 @ifnotinfo
258 @item @b{\text\}
259 @end ifnotinfo
260 @end macro
261
262 @copying
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
264
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
266
267 @quotation
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
274
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
277 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
278
279 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
280 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
281 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
282 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
283 @end quotation
284 @end copying
285
286 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
287 @direntry
288 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
289 @end direntry
290
291 @titlepage
292 @title The Org Manual
293
294 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
295 @author by Carsten Dominik
296 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
297
298 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
299 @page
300 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
301 @insertcopying
302 @end titlepage
303
304 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
305 @contents
306
307 @ifnottex
308 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
309 @top Org Mode Manual
310
311 @insertcopying
312 @end ifnottex
313
314 @menu
315 * Introduction:: Getting started
316 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
317 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
318 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
319 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
320 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
321 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
322 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
323 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
324 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
325 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
326 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
327 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
328 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
329 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
330 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
331 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
332 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
333 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
334 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
335 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
336 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
337
338 @detailmenu
339 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
340
341 Introduction
342
343 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
344 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
345 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
346 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
347 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
348
349 Document structure
350
351 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
352 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
353 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
354 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
355 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
356 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
357 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
358 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
359 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
360 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
361 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
362
363 Tables
364
365 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
366 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
367 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
368 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
369 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
370 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
371
372 The spreadsheet
373
374 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
375 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
376 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
377 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
378 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
379 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
380 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
381 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
382 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
383
384 Hyperlinks
385
386 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
387 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
388 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
389 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
390 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
391 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
392 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
393 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
394
395 Internal links
396
397 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
398
399 TODO items
400
401 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
402 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
403 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
404 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
405 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
406 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
407
408 Extended use of TODO keywords
409
410 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
411 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
412 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
413 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
414 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
415 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
416 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
417
418 Progress logging
419
420 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
421 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
422 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
423
424 Tags
425
426 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
427 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
428 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
429
430 Properties and columns
431
432 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
433 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
434 * Property searches:: Matching property values
435 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
436 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
437 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
438
439 Column view
440
441 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
442 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
443 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
444
445 Defining columns
446
447 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
448 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
449
450 Dates and times
451
452 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
453 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
454 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
455 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
456 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
457 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
458 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
459
460 Creating timestamps
461
462 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
463 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
464
465 Deadlines and scheduling
466
467 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
468 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
469
470 Clocking work time
471
472 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
473 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
474 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
475
476 Capture - Refile - Archive
477
478 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
479 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
480 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
481 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
482 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
483 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
484
485 Capture
486
487 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
488 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
489 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
490
491 Capture templates
492
493 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
494 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
495 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
496
497 Archiving
498
499 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
500 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
501
502 Agenda views
503
504 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
505 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
506 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
507 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
508 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
509 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
510 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
511 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
512
513 The built-in agenda views
514
515 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
516 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
517 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
518 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
519 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
520 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
521
522 Presentation and sorting
523
524 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
525 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
526 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
527
528 Custom agenda views
529
530 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
531 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
532 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
533
534 Markup for rich export
535
536 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
537 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
538 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
539 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
540 * Index entries:: Making an index
541 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
542 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
543
544 Structural markup elements
545
546 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
547 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
548 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
549 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
550 * Lists:: Lists
551 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
552 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
553 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
554 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
555 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
556
557 Embedded @LaTeX{}
558
559 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
560 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
561 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
562 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
563 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
564
565 Exporting
566
567 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
568 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
569 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
570 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
571 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
572 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
573 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
574 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
575 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
576 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
577 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
578 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
579
580 HTML export
581
582 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
583 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
592
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
594
595 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
601
602 DocBook export
603
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
610
611 OpenDocument Text export
612
613 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
614 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
615 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
616 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
617 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
618 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
619 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
620 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
621 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
622 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
623 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
624
625 Math formatting in ODT export
626
627 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
628 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
629
630 Advanced topics in ODT export
631
632 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
633 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
634 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
635 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
636 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
637
638 Publishing
639
640 * Configuration:: Defining projects
641 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
642 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
643 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
644
645 Configuration
646
647 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
648 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
649 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
650 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
651 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
652 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
653 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
654 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
655
656 Sample configuration
657
658 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
659 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
660
661 Working with source code
662
663 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
664 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
665 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
666 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
667 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
668 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
669 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
670 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
671 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
672 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
673 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
674 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
675
676 Header arguments
677
678 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
679 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
680
681 Using header arguments
682
683 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
684 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
685 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
686 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
687 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
688 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
689
690 Specific header arguments
691
692 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
693 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
694 be collected and handled
695 * file:: Specify a path for file output
696 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
697 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
698 directory for code block execution
699 * exports:: Export code and/or results
700 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
701 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
702 files during tangling
703 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
704 code files
705 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
706 code files
707 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
708 expansion during tangling
709 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
710 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
711 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
712 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
713 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
714 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
715 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
716 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
717 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
718 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
719 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
720 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
721
722 Miscellaneous
723
724 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
725 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
726 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
727 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
728 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
729 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
730 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
731 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
732 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
733 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
734 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
735
736 Interaction with other packages
737
738 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
739 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
740
741 Hacking
742
743 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
744 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
745 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
746 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
747 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
748 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
749 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
750 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
751 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
752 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
753
754 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
755
756 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
757 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
758 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
759 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
760
761 MobileOrg
762
763 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
764 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
765 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
766
767 @end detailmenu
768 @end menu
769
770 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
771 @chapter Introduction
772 @cindex introduction
773
774 @menu
775 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
776 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
777 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
778 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
779 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
780 @end menu
781
782 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
783 @section Summary
784 @cindex summary
785
786 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
787 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
788
789 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
790 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
791 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
792 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
793 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
794 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
795 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
796 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
797 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
798 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
799 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
800 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
801 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
802 linked web pages.
803
804 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
805 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
806 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
807
808 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
809 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
810 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
811
812 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
813 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
814 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
815 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
816 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
817 the minor Orgstruct mode.
818
819 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
820 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
821 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
822 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
823 ends, for example:
824
825 @example
826 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
827 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
828 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
829 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
830 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
831 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
832 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
833 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
834 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
835 @end example
836
837
838 @cindex FAQ
839 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
840 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
841 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
842 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
843
844 @cindex print edition
845 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
846 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
847 Theory Ltd.}
848
849 @page
850
851
852 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
853 @section Installation
854 @cindex installation
855 @cindex XEmacs
856
857 @b{Important:} @i{If you the version of Org that comes with Emacs or as a
858 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to @ref{Activation}.
859 If you downloaded Org as an ELPA package, please read the instructions on the
860 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}. To see what version of Org
861 (if any) is part of your Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x org-version} (if
862 your Emacs distribution does not come with Org, this function will not be
863 defined).}
864
865 Installation of Org mode uses a build system, which is described in more
866 detail on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html, Worg}.
867
868 If you have downloaded Org from the Web as a distribution @file{.zip} or
869 @file{.tar.gz} archive, take the following steps to install it:
870
871 @itemize @bullet
872 @item Unpack the distribution archive.
873 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org directory.
874 @item Run @code{make help config}
875 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk} if the default configuration
876 does not match your system. Set the name of the Emacs binary (likely either
877 @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the directories where local
878 Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the Emacs binary is not in your
879 path, give the full path to the executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
880 @item Run @code{make config}
881 again to check the configuration.
882 @item Optionally run @code{make test}
883 to build Org mode and then run the full testsuite.
884 @item Run @code{make install} or @code{sudo make install}
885 to build and install Org mode on your system.
886 @end itemize
887
888 If you use a cloned Git repository, then the procedure is slightly different.
889 The following description assumes that you are using the @code{master} branch
890 (where the development is done). You could also use the @code{maint} branch
891 instead, where the release versions are published, just replace @code{master}
892 with @code{maint} in the description below.
893
894 @itemize @bullet
895 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
896 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
897 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
898 @item Run @code{make help}
899 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
900 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
901 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the
902 Emacs binary is not in your path, you must give the full path to the
903 executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
904 @item Run @code{make config}
905 to check the configuration.
906 @item Run @code{make update2} or @code{make up2}
907 to update the Git repository and build and install Org mode. The latter
908 invocation runs the complete test suite before installation and installs only
909 if the build passes all tests.
910 @end itemize
911
912 If you don't have access to the system-wide directories and you don't want to
913 install somewhere into your home directory, you can run Org directly from the
914 distribution directory or Org repository by compiling Org mode in place:
915
916 @itemize @bullet
917 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
918 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
919 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
920 @item Run @code{make compile}
921 @end itemize
922
923 Last but not least you can also run Org mode directly from an Org repository
924 without any compilation. Simply replace the last step in the recipe above
925 with @code{make uncompiled}.
926
927 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
928
929 @example
930 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
931 @end example
932
933 @noindent
934 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory without
935 compiling them, do a similar step for this directory:
936
937 @example
938 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
939 @end example
940
941 If you want to include those files with the build and install, please
942 customize the variable @code{ORG_ADD_CONTRIB} instead in your @code{local.mk}
943 file, for more details please see this
944 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html#sec-4-1-2,
945 description on Worg}.
946
947 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
948 @file{install-info} program. The Info documentation is installed together
949 with the rest of Org mode. If you don't install Org mode, it is possible to
950 install the Info documentation separately (you need to have
951 install-info@footnote{The output from install-info (if any) is system
952 dependent. In particular Debian and its derivatives use two different
953 versions of install-info and you may see the message:
954
955 @example
956 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
957 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
958 @end example
959
960 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}
961 on your system).
962
963 @example
964 make install-info
965 @end example
966
967 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
968 @page
969
970 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
971 @section Activation
972 @cindex activation
973 @cindex autoload
974 @cindex ELPA
975 @cindex global key bindings
976 @cindex key bindings, global
977 @findex org-agenda
978 @findex org-capture
979 @findex org-store-link
980 @findex org-iswitchb
981
982 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
983 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
984 @file{.emacs} file:
985
986 @lisp
987 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
988 @end lisp
989
990 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the default in
991 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
992 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
993
994 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
995 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
996
997 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
998 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
999 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
1000 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
1001 liking.
1002 @lisp
1003 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
1004 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
1005 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
1006 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
1007 @end lisp
1008
1009 @cindex Org mode, turning on
1010 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
1011 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
1012 like this:
1013
1014 @example
1015 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
1016 @end example
1017
1018 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
1019 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
1020 the file's name is. See also the variable
1021 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
1022
1023 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
1024 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
1025 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
1026 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
1027 @lisp
1028 (transient-mark-mode 1)
1029 @end lisp
1030 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
1031 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
1032 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
1033
1034 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1035 @section Feedback
1036 @cindex feedback
1037 @cindex bug reports
1038 @cindex maintainer
1039 @cindex author
1040
1041 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1042 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1043 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1044 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1045 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1046 moderators have to do.}.
1047
1048 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1049 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1050 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1051 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1052 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1053 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1054 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1055 @example
1056 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1057 @end example
1058 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1059 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1060 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1061
1062 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1063 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1064 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1065 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1066 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1067
1068 @example
1069 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1070 @end example
1071
1072 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1073 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1074 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1075 shown below.
1076
1077 @example
1078 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1079
1080 ;; activate debugging
1081 (setq debug-on-error t
1082 debug-on-signal nil
1083 debug-on-quit nil)
1084
1085 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1086 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1087 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1088 @end example
1089
1090 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1091 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1092 about:
1093
1094 @enumerate
1095 @item What exactly did you do?
1096 @item What did you expect to happen?
1097 @item What happened instead?
1098 @end enumerate
1099 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1100
1101 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1102
1103 @cindex backtrace of an error
1104 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1105 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1106 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1107 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1108 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1109
1110 @enumerate
1111 @item
1112 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1113 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1114 To do this, use
1115 @example
1116 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1117 @end example
1118 @noindent
1119 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1120 menu.
1121 @item
1122 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1123 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1124 @item
1125 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1126 document the steps you take.
1127 @item
1128 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1129 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1130 attach it to your bug report.
1131 @end enumerate
1132
1133 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1134 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1135
1136 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1137
1138 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1139 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1140
1141 @table @code
1142 @item TODO
1143 @itemx WAITING
1144 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1145 user-defined.
1146 @item boss
1147 @itemx ARCHIVE
1148 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1149 meaning are written with all capitals.
1150 @item Release
1151 @itemx PRIORITY
1152 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1153 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1154 @end table
1155
1156 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1157 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1158 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1159 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1160 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1161 @code{#+results}.}
1162
1163 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1164 @kindex C-c a
1165 @findex org-agenda
1166 @kindex C-c c
1167 @findex org-capture
1168
1169 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1170 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1171 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1172
1173 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1174 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1175 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1176 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1177 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1178 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1179 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1180 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1181 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1182 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1183
1184 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1185 @chapter Document structure
1186 @cindex document structure
1187 @cindex structure of document
1188
1189 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1190 edit the structure of the document.
1191
1192 @menu
1193 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1194 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1195 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1196 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1197 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1198 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1199 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1200 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1201 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1202 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1203 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1204 @end menu
1205
1206 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1207 @section Outlines
1208 @cindex outlines
1209 @cindex Outline mode
1210
1211 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1212 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1213 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1214 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1215 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1216 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1217 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1218 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1219
1220 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1221 @section Headlines
1222 @cindex headlines
1223 @cindex outline tree
1224 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1225 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1226 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1227
1228 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1229 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1230 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1231 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1232 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1233 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1234
1235 @example
1236 * Top level headline
1237 ** Second level
1238 *** 3rd level
1239 some text
1240 *** 3rd level
1241 more text
1242
1243 * Another top level headline
1244 @end example
1245
1246 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1247 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1248 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1249
1250 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1251 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1252 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1253 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1254 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1255 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1256
1257 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1258 @section Visibility cycling
1259 @cindex cycling, visibility
1260 @cindex visibility cycling
1261 @cindex trees, visibility
1262 @cindex show hidden text
1263 @cindex hide text
1264
1265 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1266 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1267 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1268
1269 @cindex subtree visibility states
1270 @cindex subtree cycling
1271 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1272 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1273 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1274 @table @asis
1275 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1276 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1277
1278 @example
1279 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1280 '-----------------------------------'
1281 @end example
1282
1283 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1284 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1285 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1286 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1287 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1288 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1289 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1290 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1291
1292 @cindex global visibility states
1293 @cindex global cycling
1294 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1295 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1296 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1297 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1298 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1299 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1300
1301 @example
1302 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1303 '--------------------------------------'
1304 @end example
1305
1306 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1307 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1308 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1309
1310 @cindex show all, command
1311 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1312 Show all, including drawers.
1313 @cindex revealing context
1314 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1315 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1316 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1317 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1318 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1319 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1320 entire subtree of the parent.
1321 @cindex show branches, command
1322 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1323 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1324 @cindex show children, command
1325 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1326 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1327 expose all children down to level N@.
1328 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1329 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1330 buffer
1331 @ifinfo
1332 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1333 @end ifinfo
1334 @ifnotinfo
1335 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1336 @end ifnotinfo
1337 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1338 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1339 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1340 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1341 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1342 the previously used indirect buffer.
1343 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1344 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1345 @end table
1346
1347 @vindex org-startup-folded
1348 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1349 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1350 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1351 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1352
1353 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1354 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1355 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1356 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1357 buffer:
1358
1359 @example
1360 #+STARTUP: overview
1361 #+STARTUP: content
1362 #+STARTUP: showall
1363 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1364 @end example
1365
1366 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1367 @noindent
1368 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1369 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1370 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1371 @code{all}.
1372 @table @asis
1373 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1374 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1375 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1376 entries.
1377 @end table
1378
1379 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1380 @section Motion
1381 @cindex motion, between headlines
1382 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1383 @cindex headline navigation
1384 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1385
1386 @table @asis
1387 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1388 Next heading.
1389 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1390 Previous heading.
1391 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1392 Next heading same level.
1393 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1394 Previous heading same level.
1395 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1396 Backward to higher level heading.
1397 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1398 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1399 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1400 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1401 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1402 @example
1403 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1404 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1405 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1406 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1407 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1408 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1409 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1410 u @r{One level up.}
1411 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1412 q @r{Quit}
1413 @end example
1414 @vindex org-goto-interface
1415 @noindent
1416 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1417 @end table
1418
1419 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1420 @section Structure editing
1421 @cindex structure editing
1422 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1423 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1424 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1425 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1426 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1427 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1428 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1429 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1430 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1431
1432 @table @asis
1433 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1434 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1435 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1436 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1437 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1438 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1439 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1440 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1441 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1442 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1443 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1444 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1445 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1446 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1447 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1448 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1449 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1450 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1451 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1452 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1453 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1454 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1455 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1456 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1457 subtree.
1458 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1459 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1460 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1461 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1462 to the initial level.
1463 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1464 Promote current heading by one level.
1465 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1466 Demote current heading by one level.
1467 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1468 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1469 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1470 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1471 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1472 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1473 level).
1474 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1475 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1476 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1477 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1478 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1479 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1480 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1481 sequential subtrees.
1482 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1483 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1484 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1485 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1486 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1487 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1488 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1489 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1490 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1491 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1492 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1493 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1494 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1495 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1496 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1497 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1498 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1499 folding.
1500 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1501 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1502 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1503 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1504 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1505 more details, see the docstring of the command
1506 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1507 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1508 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1509 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1510 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1511 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1512 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1513 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1514 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1515 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1516 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1517 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1518 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1519 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1520 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1521 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1522 Narrow buffer to current block.
1523 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1524 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1525 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1526 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1527 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1528 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1529 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1530 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1531 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1532 @end table
1533
1534 @cindex region, active
1535 @cindex active region
1536 @cindex transient mark mode
1537 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1538 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1539 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1540 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1541 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1542 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1543 functionality.
1544
1545
1546 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1547 @section Sparse trees
1548 @cindex sparse trees
1549 @cindex trees, sparse
1550 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1551 @cindex occur, command
1552
1553 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1554 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1555 @vindex org-show-siblings
1556 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1557 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1558 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1559 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1560 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1561 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1562 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1563 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1564 and you will see immediately how it works.
1565
1566 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1567 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1568
1569 @table @asis
1570 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1571 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1572 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1573 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1574 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1575 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1576 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1577 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1578 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1579 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1580 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1581 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1582 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1583 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1584 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1585 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1586 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1587 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1588 @end table
1589
1590
1591 @noindent
1592 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1593 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1594 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1595 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1596 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1597 For example:
1598
1599 @lisp
1600 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1601 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1602 @end lisp
1603
1604 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1605 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1606
1607 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1608 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1609
1610 @kindex C-c C-e v
1611 @cindex printing sparse trees
1612 @cindex visible text, printing
1613 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1614 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1615 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1616 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1617 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1618 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1619
1620 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1621 @section Plain lists
1622 @cindex plain lists
1623 @cindex lists, plain
1624 @cindex lists, ordered
1625 @cindex ordered lists
1626
1627 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1628 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1629 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1630 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1631
1632 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1633 @itemize @bullet
1634 @item
1635 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1636 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1637 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1638 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1639 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1640 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1641 bullets.
1642 @item
1643 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1644 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1645 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1646 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1647 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1648 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1649 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1650 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1651 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1652 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1653 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1654 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1655 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1656 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1657 @item
1658 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1659 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1660 description.
1661 @end itemize
1662
1663 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1664 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1665 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1666 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1667 than its bullet/number.
1668
1669 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1670 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1671 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1672 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1673 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1674
1675 @example
1676 @group
1677 ** Lord of the Rings
1678 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1679 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1680 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1681 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1682 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1683 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1684 - on DVD only
1685 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1686 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1687 Important actors in this film are:
1688 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1689 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1690 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1691 @end group
1692 @end example
1693
1694 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1695 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1696 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1697 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1698 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1699 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1700 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1701
1702 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1703 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1704 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1705 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1706 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1707 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1708 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1709
1710 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1711 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1712 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1713 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1714 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1715 to disable them individually.
1716
1717 @table @asis
1718 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1719 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1720 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1721 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1722 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1723 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1724 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1725 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1726 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1727 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1728 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1729 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1730 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1731 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1732 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1733 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1734 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1735 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1736 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1737 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1738 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1739 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1740 one.
1741 @end table
1742
1743 @table @kbd
1744 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1745 @item M-S-RET
1746 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1747 @kindex S-@key{down}
1748 @item S-up
1749 @itemx S-down
1750 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1751 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1752 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1753 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1754 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1755 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1756 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1757 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1758 similar effect.
1759 @kindex M-@key{up}
1760 @kindex M-@key{down}
1761 @item M-up
1762 @itemx M-down
1763 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1764 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1765 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1766 is automatic.
1767 @kindex M-@key{left}
1768 @kindex M-@key{right}
1769 @item M-left
1770 @itemx M-right
1771 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1772 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1773 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1774 @item M-S-left
1775 @itemx M-S-right
1776 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1777 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1778 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1779 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1780 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1781 motion or so.
1782
1783 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1784 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1785 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1786 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1787 @kindex C-c C-c
1788 @item C-c C-c
1789 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1790 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1791 consistency in the whole list.
1792 @kindex C-c -
1793 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1794 @item C-c -
1795 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1796 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1797 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1798 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1799 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1800 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1801 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1802 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1803 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1804 @kindex C-c *
1805 @item C-c *
1806 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1807 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1808 @kindex C-c C-*
1809 @item C-c C-*
1810 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1811 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1812 (resp. checked).
1813 @kindex S-@key{left}
1814 @kindex S-@key{right}
1815 @item S-left/right
1816 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1817 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1818 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1819 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1820 @kindex C-c ^
1821 @item C-c ^
1822 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1823 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1824 @end table
1825
1826 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1827 @section Drawers
1828 @cindex drawers
1829 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1830 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1831
1832 @vindex org-drawers
1833 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1834 @kindex C-c C-x d
1835 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1836 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1837 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1838 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1839 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1840 look like this:
1841
1842 @example
1843 ** This is a headline
1844 Still outside the drawer
1845 :DRAWERNAME:
1846 This is inside the drawer.
1847 :END:
1848 After the drawer.
1849 @end example
1850
1851 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1852 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1853 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1854 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1855 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1856 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1857
1858 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1859 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1860 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1861 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1862 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1863 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1864 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1865 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1866
1867 @table @kbd
1868 @kindex C-c C-z
1869 @item C-c C-z
1870 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1871 @end table
1872
1873 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1874 @section Blocks
1875
1876 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1877 @cindex blocks, folding
1878 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1879 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1880 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1881 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1882 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1883 or on a per-file basis by using
1884
1885 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1886 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1887 @example
1888 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1889 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1890 @end example
1891
1892 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1893 @section Footnotes
1894 @cindex footnotes
1895
1896 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1897 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1898 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1899 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1900 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1901 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1902 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1903 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1904
1905 @example
1906 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1907 ...
1908 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1909 @end example
1910
1911 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1912 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1913 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1914 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1915 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1916
1917 @table @code
1918 @item [1]
1919 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1920 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1921 snippet.
1922 @item [fn:name]
1923 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1924 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1925 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1926 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1927 reference point.
1928 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1929 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1930 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1931 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1932 @end table
1933
1934 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1935 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1936 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1937 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1938 for details.
1939
1940 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1941
1942 @table @kbd
1943 @kindex C-c C-x f
1944 @item C-c C-x f
1945 The footnote action command.
1946
1947 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1948 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1949
1950 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1951 @vindex org-footnote-section
1952 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1953 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1954 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1955 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1956 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1957 separately into the location determined by the variable
1958 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1959
1960 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1961 options is offered:
1962 @example
1963 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1964 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1965 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1966 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1967 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1968 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1969 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1970 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1971 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1972 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1973 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1974 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1975 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1976 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1977 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1978 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1979 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1980 @r{to it.}
1981 @end example
1982 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1983 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1984 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1985 deletion.
1986
1987 @kindex C-c C-c
1988 @item C-c C-c
1989 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1990 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1991 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1992 @kindex C-c C-o
1993 @kindex mouse-1
1994 @kindex mouse-2
1995 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1996 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1997 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1998 @end table
1999
2000 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
2001 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
2002 @cindex Orgstruct mode
2003 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
2004
2005 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2006 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
2007 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
2008 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
2009 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2010
2011 @lisp
2012 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2013 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2014 @end lisp
2015
2016 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2017 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2018 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2019 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2020 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
2021 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
2022 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
2023 item.
2024
2025 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2026 @chapter Tables
2027 @cindex tables
2028 @cindex editing tables
2029
2030 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2031 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2032 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2033
2034 @menu
2035 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2036 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2037 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2038 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2039 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2040 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2041 @end menu
2042
2043 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2044 @section The built-in table editor
2045 @cindex table editor, built-in
2046
2047 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2048 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2049 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2050 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2051 might look like this:
2052
2053 @example
2054 | Name | Phone | Age |
2055 |-------+-------+-----|
2056 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2057 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2058 @end example
2059
2060 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2061 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2062 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2063 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2064 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2065 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2066 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2067 create the above table, you would only type
2068
2069 @example
2070 |Name|Phone|Age|
2071 |-
2072 @end example
2073
2074 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2075 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2076 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2077
2078 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2079 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2080 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2081 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2082 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2083 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2084 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2085 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2086 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2087 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2088
2089 @table @kbd
2090 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2091 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2092 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2093 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2094 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2095 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2096 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2097 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2098 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2099 @*
2100 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2101 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2102 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2103
2104 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2105 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2106 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2107 @c
2108 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2109 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2110 necessary.
2111 @c
2112 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2113 Re-align, move to previous field.
2114 @c
2115 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2116 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2117 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2118 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2119 @c
2120 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2121 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2122 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2123 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2124
2125 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2126 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2127 Move the current column left/right.
2128 @c
2129 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2130 Kill the current column.
2131 @c
2132 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2133 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2134 @c
2135 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2136 Move the current row up/down.
2137 @c
2138 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2139 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2140 @c
2141 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2142 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2143 created below the current one.
2144 @c
2145 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2146 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2147 is created above the current line.
2148 @c
2149 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2150 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2151 below that line.
2152 @c
2153 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2154 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2155 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2156 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2157 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2158 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2159 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2160 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2161 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2162 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2163
2164 @tsubheading{Regions}
2165 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2166 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2167 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2168 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2169 @c
2170 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2171 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2172 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2173 @c
2174 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2175 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2176 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2177 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2178 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2179 lines.
2180 @c
2181 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2182 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2183 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2184 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2185 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2186 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2187 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2188 above.
2189
2190 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2191 @cindex formula, in tables
2192 @cindex calculations, in tables
2193 @cindex region, active
2194 @cindex active region
2195 @cindex transient mark mode
2196 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2197 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2198 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2199 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2200 @c
2201 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2202 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2203 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2204 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2205 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2206 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2207 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2208 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2209 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2210
2211 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2212 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2213 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2214 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2215 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2216 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2217 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2218 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2219 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2220 @c
2221 @item M-x org-table-import
2222 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2223 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2224 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2225 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2226 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2227 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2228 separator.
2229 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2230 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2231 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2232 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2233 @c
2234 @item M-x org-table-export
2235 @findex org-table-export
2236 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2237 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2238 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2239 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2240 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2241 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2242 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2243 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2244 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2245 detailed description.
2246 @end table
2247
2248 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2249 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2250 it off with
2251
2252 @lisp
2253 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2254 @end lisp
2255
2256 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2257 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2258
2259 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2260 @section Column width and alignment
2261 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2262 @cindex alignment in tables
2263
2264 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2265 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2266 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2267
2268 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2269 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2270 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2271 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2272 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2273 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2274 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2275
2276 @example
2277 @group
2278 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2279 | | | | | <6> |
2280 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2281 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2282 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2283 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2284 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2285 @end group
2286 @end example
2287
2288 @noindent
2289 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2290 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2291 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2292 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2293 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2294 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2295 C-c}.
2296
2297 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2298 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2299 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2300 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2301 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2302 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2303 on a per-file basis with:
2304
2305 @example
2306 #+STARTUP: align
2307 #+STARTUP: noalign
2308 @end example
2309
2310 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2311 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2312 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2313 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2314 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2315
2316 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2317 automatically when exporting the document.
2318
2319 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2320 @section Column groups
2321 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2322
2323 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2324 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2325 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2326 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2327 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2328 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2329 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2330 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2331 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2332 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2333 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2334
2335 @example
2336 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2337 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2338 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2339 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2340 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2341 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2342 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2343 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2344 @end example
2345
2346 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2347 every vertical line you would like to have:
2348
2349 @example
2350 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2351 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2352 | / | < | | | < | |
2353 @end example
2354
2355 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2356 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2357 @cindex Orgtbl mode
2358 @cindex minor mode for tables
2359
2360 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2361 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2362 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2363 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2364 example in Message mode, use
2365
2366 @lisp
2367 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2368 @end lisp
2369
2370 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2371 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2372 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2373 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2374 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2375
2376 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2377 @section The spreadsheet
2378 @cindex calculations, in tables
2379 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2380 @cindex @file{calc} package
2381
2382 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2383 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2384 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2385 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2386 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2387 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2388 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2389 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2390 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2391
2392 @menu
2393 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2394 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2395 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2396 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2397 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2398 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2399 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2400 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2401 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2402 @end menu
2403
2404 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2405 @subsection References
2406 @cindex references
2407
2408 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2409 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2410 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2411 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2412 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2413
2414 @subsubheading Field references
2415 @cindex field references
2416 @cindex references, to fields
2417
2418 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2419 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2420 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2421 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2422 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2423 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2424 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2425 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2426 representation that looks like this:
2427 @example
2428 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2429 @end example
2430
2431 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2432 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2433 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2434 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2435 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2436 column from the right.
2437
2438 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2439 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2440 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2441 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2442 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2443 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2444 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2445 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2446 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2447 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2448 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2449 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2450 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2451 after the third hline in the table.
2452
2453 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2454 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2455 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2456 implied.
2457
2458 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2459 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2460 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2461 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2462 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2463 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2464
2465 Here are a few examples:
2466
2467 @example
2468 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2469 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2470 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2471 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2472 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2473 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2474 @end example
2475
2476 @subsubheading Range references
2477 @cindex range references
2478 @cindex references, to ranges
2479
2480 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2481 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2482 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2483 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2484 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2485 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2486
2487 @example
2488 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2489 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2490 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2491 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2492 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2493 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2494 @end example
2495
2496 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2497 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2498 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2499 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2500 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2501
2502 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2503 @cindex field coordinates
2504 @cindex coordinates, of field
2505 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2506 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2507
2508 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2509 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2510 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2511 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2512
2513 @example
2514 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2515 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2516 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2517 @end example
2518
2519 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2520 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2521 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2522 number of rows.
2523
2524 @subsubheading Named references
2525 @cindex named references
2526 @cindex references, named
2527 @cindex name, of column or field
2528 @cindex constants, in calculations
2529 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2530
2531 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2532 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2533 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2534 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2535 line like
2536
2537 @example
2538 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2539 @end example
2540
2541 @noindent
2542 @vindex constants-unit-system
2543 @pindex constants.el
2544 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2545 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2546 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2547 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2548 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2549 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2550 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2551 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2552 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2553 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2554 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2555 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2556 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2557 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2558 numbers.
2559
2560 @subsubheading Remote references
2561 @cindex remote references
2562 @cindex references, remote
2563 @cindex references, to a different table
2564 @cindex name, of column or field
2565 @cindex constants, in calculations
2566 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2567
2568 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2569 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2570
2571 @example
2572 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2573 @end example
2574
2575 @noindent
2576 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2577 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2578 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2579 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2580 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2581 referenced table.
2582
2583 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2584 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2585 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2586 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2587
2588 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2589 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2590 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2591 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2592 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2593 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2594 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2595 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2596 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2597 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2598 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2599
2600 @cindex format specifier
2601 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2602 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2603 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2604 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2605 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2606 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2607 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2608 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2609 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2610
2611 @example
2612 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2613 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2614 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2615 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2616 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2617 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2618 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2619 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2620 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2621 L @r{literal}
2622 @end example
2623
2624 @noindent
2625 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2626 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2627 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2628 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2629 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2630 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2631 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2632 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2633 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2634 A few examples:
2635
2636 @example
2637 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2638 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2639 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2640 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2641 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2642 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2643 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2644 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2645 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2646 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2647 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2648 @end example
2649
2650 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2651
2652 @example
2653 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2654 @end example
2655
2656 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2657 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2658
2659 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2660 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2661 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2662
2663 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2664 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2665 not enough.
2666
2667 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2668 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2669 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2670 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2671
2672 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2673 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2674 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2675 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2676 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2677 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2678 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2679 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2680 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2681 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2682
2683 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2684 computations in Lisp:
2685
2686 @example
2687 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2688 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2689 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2690 '(+ $1 $2);N
2691 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2692 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2693 @end example
2694
2695 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2696 @subsection Durations and time values
2697 @cindex Duration, computing
2698 @cindex Time, computing
2699 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2700
2701 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2702 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2703
2704 @example
2705 @group
2706 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2707 |---------+----------+----------|
2708 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2709 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2710 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2711 @end group
2712 @end example
2713
2714 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2715 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2716 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2717 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2718 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2719 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2720 example above).
2721
2722 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2723 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2724
2725 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2726 @subsection Field and range formulas
2727 @cindex field formula
2728 @cindex range formula
2729 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2730 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2731
2732 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2733 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2734 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2735 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2736 current field will be replaced with the result.
2737
2738 @cindex #+TBLFM
2739 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2740 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2741 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2742 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2743 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2744 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2745 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2746 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2747 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2748 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2749 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2750
2751 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2752 command
2753
2754 @table @kbd
2755 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2756 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2757 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2758 it to the current field, and stores it.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2762 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2763 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2764 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2765 directly.
2766
2767 @table @code
2768 @item $2=
2769 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2770 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2771 @item @@3=
2772 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2773 the last row.
2774 @item @@1$2..@@4$3=
2775 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2776 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2777 @item $name=
2778 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2779 @end table
2780
2781 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2782 @subsection Column formulas
2783 @cindex column formula
2784 @cindex formula, for table column
2785
2786 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2787 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2788 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2789 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2790 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2791 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2792 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2793
2794 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2795 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2796 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2797 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2798 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2799 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2800 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2801 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2802 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2803 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2804
2805 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2806 following command:
2807
2808 @table @kbd
2809 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2810 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2811 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2812 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2813 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2814 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2815 @end table
2816
2817 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2818 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2819 @cindex formula editing
2820 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2821
2822 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2823 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2824 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2825 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2826 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2827 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2828 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2829 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2830
2831 @table @kbd
2832 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2833 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2834 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2835 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2836 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2837 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2838 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2839 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2840 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2841 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2842 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2843 @kindex C-c @}
2844 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2845 @item C-c @}
2846 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2847 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2848 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2849 @kindex C-c @{
2850 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2851 @item C-c @{
2852 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2853 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2854 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2855 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2856 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2857 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2858 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2859 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2860 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2861 @table @kbd
2862 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2863 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2864 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2865 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2866 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2867 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2868 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2869 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2870 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2871 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2872 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2873 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2874 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2875 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2876 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2877 @kindex S-@key{up}
2878 @kindex S-@key{down}
2879 @kindex S-@key{left}
2880 @kindex S-@key{right}
2881 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2882 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2883 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2884 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2885 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2886 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2887 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2888 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2889 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2890 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2891 down.
2892 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2893 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2894 @kindex C-c @}
2895 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2896 @item C-c @}
2897 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2898 @end table
2899 @end table
2900
2901 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2902 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2903 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2904 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2905 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2906
2907 @kindex C-c C-c
2908 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2909 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2910 recalculation commands in the table.
2911
2912 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2913 @cindex formula debugging
2914 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2915 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2916 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2917 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2918 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2919 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2920 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2921
2922 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2923 @subsection Updating the table
2924 @cindex recomputing table fields
2925 @cindex updating, table
2926
2927 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2928 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2929 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2930
2931 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2932 following commands:
2933
2934 @table @kbd
2935 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2936 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2937 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2938 @c
2939 @kindex C-u C-c *
2940 @item C-u C-c *
2941 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2942 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2943 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2944 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2945 @c
2946 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2947 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2948 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2949 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2950 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2951 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2952 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2953 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2954 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2955 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2956 dependencies.
2957 @end table
2958
2959 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2960 @subsection Advanced features
2961
2962 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2963 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2964 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2965 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2966 special marking characters.
2967
2968 @table @kbd
2969 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2970 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2971 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2972 change all marks in the region.
2973 @end table
2974
2975 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2976 makes use of these features:
2977
2978 @example
2979 @group
2980 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2981 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2982 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2983 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2984 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2985 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2986 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2987 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2988 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2989 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2990 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2991 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2992 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2993 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2994 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2995 @end group
2996 @end example
2997
2998 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2999 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
3000 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3001 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3002 empty first field.
3003
3004 @cindex marking characters, tables
3005 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3006 @table @samp
3007 @item !
3008 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3009 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3010 @item ^
3011 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3012 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3013 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3014 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3015 @item _
3016 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3017 @emph{below}.
3018 @item $
3019 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3020 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3021 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3022 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3023 a per-table basis.
3024 @item #
3025 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3026 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3027 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3028 lines will be left alone by this command.
3029 @item *
3030 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3031 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3032 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3033 @item
3034 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3035 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3036 or @samp{*}.
3037 @item /
3038 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3039 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3040 @end table
3041
3042 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3043 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3044 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3045 functions.
3046
3047 @example
3048 @group
3049 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3050 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3051 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3052 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3053 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3054 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3055 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3056 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3057 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3058 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3059 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3060 @end group
3061 @end example
3062
3063 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3064 @section Org-Plot
3065 @cindex graph, in tables
3066 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3067 @cindex #+PLOT
3068
3069 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3070 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3071 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3072 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3073 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3074
3075 @example
3076 @group
3077 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3078 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3079 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3080 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3081 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3082 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3083 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3084 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3085 @end group
3086 @end example
3087
3088 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3089 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3090 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3091 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3092 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3093 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3094
3095 @subsubheading Plot Options
3096
3097 @table @code
3098 @item set
3099 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3100
3101 @item title
3102 Specify the title of the plot.
3103
3104 @item ind
3105 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3106
3107 @item deps
3108 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3109 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3110 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3111 column).
3112
3113 @item type
3114 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3115
3116 @item with
3117 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3118 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3119 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3120
3121 @item file
3122 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3123
3124 @item labels
3125 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3126 if they exist).
3127
3128 @item line
3129 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3130
3131 @item map
3132 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3133 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3134
3135 @item timefmt
3136 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3137 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3138
3139 @item script
3140 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3141 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3142 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3143 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3144 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3145 the data file.
3146 @end table
3147
3148 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3149 @chapter Hyperlinks
3150 @cindex hyperlinks
3151
3152 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3153 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3154
3155 @menu
3156 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3157 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3158 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3159 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3160 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3161 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3162 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3163 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3164 @end menu
3165
3166 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3167 @section Link format
3168 @cindex link format
3169 @cindex format, of links
3170
3171 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3172 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3173
3174 @example
3175 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3176 @end example
3177
3178 @noindent
3179 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3180 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3181 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3182 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3183 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3184 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3185 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3186 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3187 cursor on the link.
3188
3189 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3190 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3191 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3192 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3193 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3194 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3195 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3196
3197 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3198 @section Internal links
3199 @cindex internal links
3200 @cindex links, internal
3201 @cindex targets, for links
3202
3203 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3204 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3205 current file. The most important case is a link like
3206 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3207 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3208 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3209 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3210 in a file.
3211
3212 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3213 lead to a text search in the current file.
3214
3215 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3216 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3217 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3218 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3219 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3220 comment line. For example
3221
3222 @example
3223 # <<My Target>>
3224 @end example
3225
3226 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3227 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3228 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3229 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3230 first headline.}.
3231
3232 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3233 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3234 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3235 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3236 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3237 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3238 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3239
3240 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3241 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3242 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3243 earlier.
3244
3245 @menu
3246 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3247 @end menu
3248
3249 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3250 @subsection Radio targets
3251 @cindex radio targets
3252 @cindex targets, radio
3253 @cindex links, radio targets
3254
3255 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3256 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3257 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3258 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3259 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3260 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3261 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3262 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3263 cursor on or at a target.
3264
3265 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3266 @section External links
3267 @cindex links, external
3268 @cindex external links
3269 @cindex links, external
3270 @cindex Gnus links
3271 @cindex BBDB links
3272 @cindex IRC links
3273 @cindex URL links
3274 @cindex file links
3275 @cindex VM links
3276 @cindex RMAIL links
3277 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3278 @cindex MH-E links
3279 @cindex USENET links
3280 @cindex SHELL links
3281 @cindex Info links
3282 @cindex Elisp links
3283
3284 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3285 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3286 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3287 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3288 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3289
3290 @example
3291 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3292 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3293 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3294 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3295 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3296 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3297 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3298 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3299 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3300 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3301 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3302 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3303 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3304 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3305 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3306 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3307 will be queried to create it.}
3308 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3309 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3310 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3311 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3312 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3313 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3314 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3315 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3316 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3317 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3318 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3319 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3320 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3321 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3322 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3323 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3324 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3325 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3326 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3327 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3328 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3329 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3330 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3331 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3332 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3333 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3334 @end example
3335
3336 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3337
3338 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3339 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3340 format}), for example:
3341
3342 @example
3343 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3344 @end example
3345
3346 @noindent
3347 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3348 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3349 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3350 image,
3351 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3352
3353 @cindex square brackets, around links
3354 @cindex plain text external links
3355 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3356 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3357 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3358 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3359
3360 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3361 @section Handling links
3362 @cindex links, handling
3363
3364 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3365 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3366
3367 @table @kbd
3368 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3369 @cindex storing links
3370 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3371 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3372 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3373 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3374 buffer:
3375
3376 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3377 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3378 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3379 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3380 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3381 timestamp in the headline.}.
3382
3383 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3384 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3385 @cindex property, ID
3386 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3387 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3388 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3389 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3390 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3391 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3392 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3393 to use.
3394
3395 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3396 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3397 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3398 constructed from the author and the subject.
3399
3400 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3401 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3402
3403 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3404 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3405
3406 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
3407 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3408 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3409 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3410 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3411 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3412
3413 @b{Other files}@*
3414 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3415 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3416 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3417 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3418 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3419 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3420 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3421
3422 @b{Agenda view}@*
3423 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3424 entry referenced by the current line.
3425
3426 @c
3427 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3428 @cindex link completion
3429 @cindex completion, of links
3430 @cindex inserting links
3431 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3432 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3433 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3434 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3435 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3436 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3437 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3438 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3439 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3440 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3441 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3442 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3443 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3444 becomes the default description.
3445
3446 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3447 All links stored during the
3448 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3449 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3450
3451 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3452 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3453 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3454 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3455 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3456 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3457 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3458 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3459 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3460 @orgkey C-u C-c C-l
3461 @cindex file name completion
3462 @cindex completion, of file names
3463 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3464 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3465 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3466 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3467 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3468 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3469 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3470 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3471 @c
3472 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3473 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3474 link and description parts of the link.
3475 @c
3476 @cindex following links
3477 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3478 @vindex org-file-apps
3479 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3480 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3481 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3482 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3483 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3484 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3485 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3486 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3487 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3488 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3489 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3490 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3491 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3492 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3493 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3494 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3495
3496 @orgkey @key{RET}
3497 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3498 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3499 the link at point.
3500 @c
3501 @kindex mouse-2
3502 @kindex mouse-1
3503 @item mouse-2
3504 @itemx mouse-1
3505 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3506 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3507 @c
3508 @kindex mouse-3
3509 @item mouse-3
3510 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3511 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3512 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3513 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3514 @c
3515 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3516 @cindex inlining images
3517 @cindex images, inlining
3518 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3519 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3520 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3521 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3522 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3523 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3524 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3525 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3526 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3527 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3528 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3529 @cindex mark ring
3530 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3531 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3532 @c
3533 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3534 @cindex links, returning to
3535 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3536 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3537 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3538 previously recorded positions.
3539 @c
3540 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3541 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3542 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3543 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3544 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3545 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3546 @lisp
3547 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3548 (lambda ()
3549 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3550 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3551 @end lisp
3552 @end table
3553
3554 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3555 @section Using links outside Org
3556
3557 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3558 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3559 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3560 yourself):
3561
3562 @lisp
3563 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3564 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3565 @end lisp
3566
3567 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3568 @section Link abbreviations
3569 @cindex link abbreviations
3570 @cindex abbreviation, links
3571
3572 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3573 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3574 abbreviated link looks like this
3575
3576 @example
3577 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3578 @end example
3579
3580 @noindent
3581 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3582 where the tag is optional.
3583 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3584 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3585 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3586 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3587
3588 @smalllisp
3589 @group
3590 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3591 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3592 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3593 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3594 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3595 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3596 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3597 @end group
3598 @end smalllisp
3599
3600 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3601 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3602 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3603 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3604 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3605
3606 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3607 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3608
3609 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3610 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3611
3612 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3613 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3614 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3615 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3616 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3617 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3618 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3619
3620 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3621 can define them in the file with
3622
3623 @cindex #+LINK
3624 @example
3625 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3626 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3627 @end example
3628
3629 @noindent
3630 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3631 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3632 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3633 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3634 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3635
3636 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3637 @section Search options in file links
3638 @cindex search option in file links
3639 @cindex file links, searching
3640
3641 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3642 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3643 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3644 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3645 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3646 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3647 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3648 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3649
3650 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3651 link, together with an explanation:
3652
3653 @example
3654 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3655 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3656 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3657 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3658 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3659 @end example
3660
3661 @table @code
3662 @item 255
3663 Jump to line 255.
3664 @item My Target
3665 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3666 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3667 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3668 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3669 the linked file.
3670 @item *My Target
3671 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3672 @item #my-custom-id
3673 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3674 @item /regexp/
3675 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3676 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3677 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3678 sparse tree with the matches.
3679 @c If the target file is a directory,
3680 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3681 @end table
3682
3683 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3684 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3685 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3686 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3687
3688 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3689 @section Custom Searches
3690 @cindex custom search strings
3691 @cindex search strings, custom
3692
3693 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3694 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3695 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3696 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3697 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3698 citation key.
3699
3700 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3701 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3702 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3703 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3704 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3705 to be added to the hook variables
3706 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3707 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3708 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3709 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3710 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3711
3712 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3713 @chapter TODO items
3714 @cindex TODO items
3715
3716 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3717 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3718 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3719 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3720 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3721 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3722 item emerged is always present.
3723
3724 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3725 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3726 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3727
3728 @menu
3729 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3730 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3731 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3732 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3733 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3734 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3735 @end menu
3736
3737 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3738 @section Basic TODO functionality
3739
3740 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3741 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3742
3743 @example
3744 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3745 @end example
3746
3747 @noindent
3748 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3749
3750 @table @kbd
3751 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3752 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3753 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3754
3755 @example
3756 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3757 '--------------------------------'
3758 @end example
3759
3760 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3761 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3762
3763 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3764 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3765 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3766 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3767 more information.
3768
3769 @kindex S-@key{right}
3770 @kindex S-@key{left}
3771 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3772 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3773 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3774 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3775 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3776 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3777 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3778 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3779 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3780 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3781 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3782 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3783 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3784 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3785 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3786 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3787 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3788 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3789 both un-done and done.
3790 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3791 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3792 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3793 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3794 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3795 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3796 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3797 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3798 @end table
3799
3800 @noindent
3801 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3802 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3803 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3804
3805 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3806 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3807 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3808
3809 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3810 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3811 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3812 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3813 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3814 files.
3815
3816 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3817 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3818
3819 @menu
3820 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3821 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3822 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3823 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3824 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3825 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3826 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3827 @end menu
3828
3829 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3830 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3831 @cindex TODO workflow
3832 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3833
3834 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3835 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3836 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3837 buffer.}:
3838
3839 @lisp
3840 (setq org-todo-keywords
3841 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3842 @end lisp
3843
3844 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3845 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3846 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3847 state.
3848 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3849 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3850 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3851 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3852 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3853 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3854 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3855 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3856 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3857 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3858 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3859
3860 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3861 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3862 @cindex TODO types
3863 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3864 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3865
3866 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3867 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3868 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3869 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3870 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3871 be set up like this:
3872
3873 @lisp
3874 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3875 @end lisp
3876
3877 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3878 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3879 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3880 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3881 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3882 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3883 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3884 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3885 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3886 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3887 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3888 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3889 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3890 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3891
3892 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3893 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3894 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3895
3896 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3897 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3898 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3899 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3900 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3901 like this:
3902
3903 @lisp
3904 (setq org-todo-keywords
3905 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3906 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3907 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3908 @end lisp
3909
3910 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3911 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3912 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3913 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3914 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3915 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3916 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3917
3918 @table @kbd
3919 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3920 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3921 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3922 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3923 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3924 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3925 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3926 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3927 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3928 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3929 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3930 @kindex S-@key{right}
3931 @kindex S-@key{left}
3932 @item S-@key{right}
3933 @itemx S-@key{left}
3934 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3935 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3936 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3937 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3938 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3939 @end table
3940
3941 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3942 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3943
3944 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3945 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3946 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3947 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3948 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3949
3950 @lisp
3951 (setq org-todo-keywords
3952 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3953 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3954 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3955 @end lisp
3956
3957 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3958 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3959 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3960 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3961 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3962 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3963 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3964 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3965
3966 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3967 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3968 @cindex keyword options
3969 @cindex per-file keywords
3970 @cindex #+TODO
3971 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3972 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3973
3974 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3975 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3976 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3977 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3978 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3979 file:
3980
3981 @example
3982 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3983 @end example
3984 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3985 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3986 @example
3987 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3988 @end example
3989
3990 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3991
3992 @example
3993 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3994 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3995 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3996 @end example
3997
3998 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3999 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4000 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4001 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4002
4003 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4004 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4005 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4006 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4007 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4008 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4009 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4010 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4011 for the current buffer.}.
4012
4013 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4014 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4015 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4016
4017 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4018 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4019 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4020 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4021 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4022 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4023 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4024 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
4025 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4026
4027 @lisp
4028 @group
4029 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4030 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4031 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4032 @end group
4033 @end lisp
4034
4035 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4036 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4037 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4038 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4039 foreground or a background color.
4040
4041 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4042 @subsection TODO dependencies
4043 @cindex TODO dependencies
4044 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4045
4046 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4047 @cindex property, ORDERED
4048 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4049 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4050 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4051 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4052 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4053 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4054 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4055 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4056 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4057 example:
4058
4059 @example
4060 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4061 ** DONE one
4062 ** TODO two
4063
4064 * Parent
4065 :PROPERTIES:
4066 :ORDERED: t
4067 :END:
4068 ** TODO a
4069 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4070 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4071 @end example
4072
4073 @table @kbd
4074 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4075 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4076 @cindex property, ORDERED
4077 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4078 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4079 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4080 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4081 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4082 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4083 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4084 @end table
4085
4086 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4087 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4088 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4089 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4090
4091 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4092 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4093 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4094 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4095 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4096 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4097
4098 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4099 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4100 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4101
4102 @page
4103 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4104 @section Progress logging
4105 @cindex progress logging
4106 @cindex logging, of progress
4107
4108 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4109 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4110 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4111 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4112 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4113 work time}.
4114
4115 @menu
4116 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4117 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4118 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4119 @end menu
4120
4121 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4122 @subsection Closing items
4123
4124 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4125 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4126 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4127
4128 @lisp
4129 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4130 @end lisp
4131
4132 @noindent
4133 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4134 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4135 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4136 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4137 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4138 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4139
4140 @lisp
4141 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4142 @end lisp
4143
4144 @noindent
4145 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4146 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4147
4148 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4149 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4150 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4151 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4152
4153 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4154 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4155 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4156
4157 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4158 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4159 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4160 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4161 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4162 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4163 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4164 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4165 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4166 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4167 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4168 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4169 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4170 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4171 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4172 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4173
4174 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4175 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4176 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4177 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4178 setting
4179
4180 @lisp
4181 (setq org-todo-keywords
4182 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4183 @end lisp
4184
4185 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4186 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4187
4188 @noindent
4189 @vindex org-log-done
4190 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4191 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4192 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4193 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4194 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4195 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4196 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4197 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4198 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4199 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4200 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4201 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4202 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4203 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4204 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4205 configured.
4206
4207 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4208 to a buffer:
4209 @example
4210 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4211 @end example
4212
4213 @cindex property, LOGGING
4214 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4215 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4216 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4217 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4218 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4219 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4220
4221 @example
4222 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4223 :PROPERTIES:
4224 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4225 :END:
4226 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4227 :PROPERTIES:
4228 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4229 :END:
4230 * TODO No logging at all
4231 :PROPERTIES:
4232 :LOGGING: nil
4233 :END:
4234 @end example
4235
4236 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4237 @subsection Tracking your habits
4238 @cindex habits
4239
4240 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4241 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4242
4243 @enumerate
4244 @item
4245 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4246 @code{org-modules}.
4247 @item
4248 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4249 @item
4250 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4251 @item
4252 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4253 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4254 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4255 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4256 @item
4257 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4258 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4259 three days, but at most every two days.
4260 @item
4261 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4262 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4263 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4264 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4265 @end enumerate
4266
4267 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4268 actual habit with some history:
4269
4270 @example
4271 ** TODO Shave
4272 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4273 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4274 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4275 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4276 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4277 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4278 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4279 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4280 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4281 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4282 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4283 :PROPERTIES:
4284 :STYLE: habit
4285 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4286 :END:
4287 @end example
4288
4289 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4290 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4291 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4292 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4293 after four days have elapsed.
4294
4295 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4296 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4297 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4298 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4299
4300 @table @code
4301 @item Blue
4302 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4303 @item Green
4304 If the task could have been done on that day.
4305 @item Yellow
4306 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4307 @item Red
4308 If the task was overdue on that day.
4309 @end table
4310
4311 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4312 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4313 the current day falls in the graph.
4314
4315 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4316 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4317
4318 @table @code
4319 @item org-habit-graph-column
4320 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4321 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4322 titles brief and to the point.
4323 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4324 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4325 @item org-habit-following-days
4326 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4327 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4328 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4329 default.
4330 @end table
4331
4332 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4333 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4334 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4335 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4336
4337 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4338 @section Priorities
4339 @cindex priorities
4340
4341 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4342 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4343 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4344
4345 @example
4346 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4347 @end example
4348
4349 @noindent
4350 @vindex org-priority-faces
4351 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4352 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4353 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4354 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4355 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4356 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4357
4358 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4359 items.
4360
4361 @table @kbd
4362 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
4363 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
4364 @findex org-priority
4365 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4366 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4367 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4368 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4369 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4370 @c
4371 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4372 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4373 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4374 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4375 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4376 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4377 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4378 @end table
4379
4380 @vindex org-highest-priority
4381 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4382 @vindex org-default-priority
4383 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4384 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4385 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4386 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4387 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4388 priority):
4389
4390 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4391 @example
4392 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
4393 @end example
4394
4395 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4396 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4397 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4398 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4399
4400 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4401 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4402 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4403 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4404 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4405 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4406 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4407 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4408 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4409
4410 @example
4411 * Organize Party [33%]
4412 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4413 *** TODO Peter
4414 *** DONE Sarah
4415 ** TODO Buy food
4416 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4417 @end example
4418
4419 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4420 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4421 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4422 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4423 this issue.
4424
4425 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4426 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4427 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4428 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4429 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4430 property.
4431
4432 @example
4433 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4434 :PROPERTIES:
4435 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4436 :END:
4437 @end example
4438
4439 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4440 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4441
4442 @example
4443 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4444 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4445 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4446 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4447
4448 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4449 @end example
4450
4451
4452 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4453 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4454
4455
4456 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4457 @section Checkboxes
4458 @cindex checkboxes
4459
4460 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4461 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4462 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4463 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4464 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4465 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4466 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4467 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4468 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4469 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4470
4471 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4472
4473 @example
4474 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4475 - [-] call people [1/3]
4476 - [ ] Peter
4477 - [X] Sarah
4478 - [ ] Sam
4479 - [X] order food
4480 - [ ] think about what music to play
4481 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4482 @end example
4483
4484 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4485 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4486 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4487 checked.
4488
4489 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4490 @cindex checkbox statistics
4491 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4492 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4493 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4494 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4495 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4496 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4497 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4498 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4499 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4500 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4501 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4502 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4503 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4504 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4505 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4506 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4507 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4508 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4509 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4510
4511 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4512 @cindex checkbox blocking
4513 @cindex property, ORDERED
4514 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4515 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4516 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4517
4518 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4519
4520 @table @kbd
4521 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4522 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4523 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4524 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4525 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4526 considered to be an intermediate state.
4527 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4528 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4529 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4530 intermediate state.
4531 @itemize @minus
4532 @item
4533 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4534 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4535 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4536 @item
4537 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4538 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4539 @item
4540 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4541 @end itemize
4542 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4543 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4544 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4545 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4546 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4547 @cindex property, ORDERED
4548 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4549 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4550 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4551 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4552 for better visibility, customize the variable
4553 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4554 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4555 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4556 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4557 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4558 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4559 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4560 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4561 @end table
4562
4563 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4564 @chapter Tags
4565 @cindex tags
4566 @cindex headline tagging
4567 @cindex matching, tags
4568 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4569
4570 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4571 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4572 support for tags.
4573
4574 @vindex org-tag-faces
4575 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4576 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4577 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4578 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4579 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4580 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4581 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4582 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4583
4584 @menu
4585 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4586 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4587 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4588 @end menu
4589
4590 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4591 @section Tag inheritance
4592 @cindex tag inheritance
4593 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4594 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4595
4596 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4597 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4598 well. For example, in the list
4599
4600 @example
4601 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4602 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4603 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4604 @end example
4605
4606 @noindent
4607 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4608 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4609 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4610 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4611 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4612 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4613 changes in the line.}:
4614
4615 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4616 @example
4617 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4618 @end example
4619
4620 @noindent
4621 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4622 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4623 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4624 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4625 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4626
4627 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4628 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4629 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4630 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4631 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4632 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4633 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4634 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4635
4636 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4637 @section Setting tags
4638 @cindex setting tags
4639 @cindex tags, setting
4640
4641 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4642 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4643 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4644 also a special command for inserting tags:
4645
4646 @table @kbd
4647 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4648 @cindex completion, of tags
4649 @vindex org-tags-column
4650 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4651 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4652 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4653 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4654 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4655 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4656 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4657 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4658 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4659 @end table
4660
4661 @vindex org-tag-alist
4662 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4663 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4664 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4665 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4666 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4667
4668 @cindex #+TAGS
4669 @example
4670 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4671 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4672 @end example
4673
4674 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4675 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4676 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4677
4678 @example
4679 #+TAGS:
4680 @end example
4681
4682 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4683 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4684 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4685 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4686 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4687 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4688
4689 @example
4690 #+STARTUP: noptag
4691 @end example
4692
4693 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4694 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4695 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4696 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4697 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4698 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4699 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4700 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4701 like:
4702
4703 @lisp
4704 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4705 @end lisp
4706
4707 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4708 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4709
4710 @example
4711 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4712 @end example
4713
4714 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4715 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4716 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4717
4718 @example
4719 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4720 @end example
4721
4722 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4723
4724 @example
4725 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4726 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4727 @end example
4728
4729 @noindent
4730 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4731 braces, as in:
4732
4733 @example
4734 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4735 @end example
4736
4737 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4738 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4739
4740 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4741 these lines to activate any changes.
4742
4743 @noindent
4744 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4745 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4746 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4747 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4748 configuration:
4749
4750 @lisp
4751 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4752 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4753 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4754 (:endgroup . nil)
4755 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4756 @end lisp
4757
4758 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4759 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4760 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4761 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4762 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4763 keys:
4764
4765 @table @kbd
4766 @item a-z...
4767 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4768 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4769 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4770 @kindex @key{TAB}
4771 @item @key{TAB}
4772 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4773 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4774 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4775
4776 @kindex @key{SPC}
4777 @item @key{SPC}
4778 Clear all tags for this line.
4779 @kindex @key{RET}
4780 @item @key{RET}
4781 Accept the modified set.
4782 @item C-g
4783 Abort without installing changes.
4784 @item q
4785 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4786 @item !
4787 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4788 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4789 @item C-c
4790 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4791 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4792 selection window.
4793 @end table
4794
4795 @noindent
4796 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4797 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4798 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4799 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4800 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4801 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4802 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4803 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4804
4805 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4806 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4807 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4808 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4809 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4810 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4811 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4812 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4813 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4814 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4815 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4816
4817 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4818 @section Tag searches
4819 @cindex tag searches
4820 @cindex searching for tags
4821
4822 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4823 information into special lists.
4824
4825 @table @kbd
4826 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4827 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4828 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4829 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4830 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4831 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4832 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4833 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4834 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4835 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4836 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4837 @end table
4838
4839 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4840 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4841 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4842 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4843 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4844 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4845 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4846
4847
4848 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4849 @chapter Properties and columns
4850 @cindex properties
4851
4852 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4853 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4854 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4855
4856 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4857 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4858 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4859 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4860 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4861 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4862 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4863 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4864 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4865
4866 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4867 (@pxref{Column view}).
4868
4869 @menu
4870 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4871 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4872 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4873 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4874 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4875 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4876 @end menu
4877
4878 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4879 @section Property syntax
4880 @cindex property syntax
4881 @cindex drawer, for properties
4882
4883 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4884 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4885 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4886 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4887 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4888
4889 @example
4890 * CD collection
4891 ** Classic
4892 *** Goldberg Variations
4893 :PROPERTIES:
4894 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4895 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4896 :Artist: Glen Gould
4897 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4898 :NDisks: 1
4899 :END:
4900 @end example
4901
4902 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4903 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4904 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4905
4906 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4907 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4908 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4909 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4910 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4911 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4912 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4913
4914 @example
4915 * CD collection
4916 :PROPERTIES:
4917 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4918 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4919 :END:
4920 @end example
4921
4922 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4923 file, use a line like
4924 @cindex property, _ALL
4925 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4926 @example
4927 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4928 @end example
4929
4930 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4931 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4932 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4933 @cindex property, +
4934 @example
4935 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4936 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4937 @end example
4938
4939 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4940 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4941 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4942 @cindex property, +
4943 @example
4944 * CD collection
4945 ** Classic
4946 :PROPERTIES:
4947 :GENRES: Classic
4948 :END:
4949 *** Goldberg Variations
4950 :PROPERTIES:
4951 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4952 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4953 :Artist: Glen Gould
4954 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4955 :NDisks: 1
4956 :GENRES+: Baroque
4957 :END:
4958 @end example
4959 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4960
4961 @vindex org-global-properties
4962 Property values set with the global variable
4963 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4964 Org files.
4965
4966 @noindent
4967 The following commands help to work with properties:
4968
4969 @table @kbd
4970 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4971 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4972 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4973 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4974 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4975 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4976 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4977 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4978 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4979 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4980 information like deadlines.
4981 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4982 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4983 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4984 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4985 can be inserted using completion.
4986 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4987 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4988 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4989 Remove a property from the current entry.
4990 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4991 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4992 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4993 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4994 nearest column format definition.
4995 @end table
4996
4997 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4998 @section Special properties
4999 @cindex properties, special
5000
5001 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5002 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5003 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5004 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5005 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5006 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5007
5008 @cindex property, special, ID
5009 @cindex property, special, TODO
5010 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5011 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5012 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5013 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5014 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5015 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5016 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5017 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5018 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5019 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5020 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5021 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5022 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5023 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5024 @cindex property, special, FILE
5025 @example
5026 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5027 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5028 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5029 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5030 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5031 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5032 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5033 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5034 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5035 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5036 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5037 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5038 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5039 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5040 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5041 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5042 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5043 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5044 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5045 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5046 @end example
5047
5048 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5049 @section Property searches
5050 @cindex properties, searching
5051 @cindex searching, of properties
5052
5053 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5054 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5055 @table @kbd
5056 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
5057 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5058 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5059 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5060 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5061 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5062 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5063 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5064 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5065 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5066 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5067 @end table
5068
5069 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5070 properties}.
5071
5072 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5073 single property:
5074
5075 @table @kbd
5076 @orgkey{C-c / p}
5077 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5078 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5079 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5080 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5081 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5082 @end table
5083
5084 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5085 @section Property Inheritance
5086 @cindex properties, inheritance
5087 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5088
5089 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5090 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5091 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5092 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5093 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5094 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5095 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5096 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5097 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5098 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5099 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5100 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5101 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5102
5103 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5104 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5105
5106 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5107 @table @code
5108 @item COLUMNS
5109 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5110 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5111 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5112 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5113 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5114 @item CATEGORY
5115 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5116 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5117 applies to the entire subtree.
5118 @item ARCHIVE
5119 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5120 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5121 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5122 @item LOGGING
5123 @cindex property, LOGGING
5124 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5125 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5126 @end table
5127
5128 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5129 @section Column view
5130
5131 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5132 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5133 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5134 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5135 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5136 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5137 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5138 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5139 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5140 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5141 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5142 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5143 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5144
5145 @menu
5146 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5147 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5148 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5149 @end menu
5150
5151 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5152 @subsection Defining columns
5153 @cindex column view, for properties
5154 @cindex properties, column view
5155
5156 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5157 done by defining a column format line.
5158
5159 @menu
5160 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5161 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5162 @end menu
5163
5164 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5165 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5166
5167 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5168
5169 @cindex #+COLUMNS
5170 @example
5171 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5172 @end example
5173
5174 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5175 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5176
5177 @example
5178 ** Top node for columns view
5179 :PROPERTIES:
5180 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5181 :END:
5182 @end example
5183
5184 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5185 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5186 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5187 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5188 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5189 deeper part of the tree.
5190
5191 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5192 @subsubsection Column attributes
5193 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5194 definition looks like this:
5195
5196 @example
5197 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5198 @end example
5199
5200 @noindent
5201 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5202 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5203
5204 @example
5205 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5206 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5207 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5208 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5209 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5210 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5211 @r{name is used.}
5212 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5213 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5214 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5215 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5216 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5217 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5218 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5219 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5220 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5221 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5222 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5223 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5224 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5225 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5226 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5227 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5228 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5229 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5230 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5231 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5232 @end example
5233
5234 @noindent
5235 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5236 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5237 same summary information.
5238
5239 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5240 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5241 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5242 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5243 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5244 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5245
5246 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5247 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5248 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5249 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5250 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5251 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5252 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5253 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5254
5255 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5256 values.
5257
5258 @example
5259 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5260 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5261 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5262 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5263 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5264 @end example
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5268 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5269 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5270 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5271 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5272 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5273 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5274 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5275 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5276 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5277 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5278 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5279 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5280 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5281 today.
5282
5283 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5284 @subsection Using column view
5285
5286 @table @kbd
5287 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5288 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5289 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5290 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5291 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5292 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5293 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5294 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5295 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5296 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5297 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5298 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5299 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5300 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5301 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5302 Same as @kbd{r}.
5303 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5304 Exit column view.
5305 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5306 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5307 Move through the column view from field to field.
5308 @kindex S-@key{left}
5309 @kindex S-@key{right}
5310 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5311 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5312 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5313 @item 1..9,0
5314 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5315 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5316 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5317 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5318 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5319 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5320 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5321 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5322 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5323 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5324 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5325 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5326 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5327 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5328 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5329 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5330 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5331 current column view.
5332 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5333 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5334 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5335 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5336 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5337 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5338 Delete the current column.
5339 @end table
5340
5341 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5342 @subsection Capturing column view
5343
5344 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5345 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5346 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5347 of this block looks like this:
5348
5349 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5350 @example
5351 * The column view
5352 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5353
5354 #+END:
5355 @end example
5356
5357 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5358
5359 @table @code
5360 @item :id
5361 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5362 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5363 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5364 capture, you can use 4 values:
5365 @cindex property, ID
5366 @example
5367 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5368 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5369 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5370 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5371 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5372 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5373 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5374 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5375 @end example
5376 @item :hlines
5377 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5378 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5379 @item :vlines
5380 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5381 @item :maxlevel
5382 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5383 @item :skip-empty-rows
5384 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5385 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5386
5387 @end table
5388
5389 @noindent
5390 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5391
5392 @table @kbd
5393 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5394 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5395 for the scope or ID of the view.
5396 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5397 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5398 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5399 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5400 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5401 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5402 blocks in a buffer.
5403 @end table
5404
5405 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5406 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5407 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5408 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5409
5410 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5411 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5412 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5413 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5414 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5415 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5416 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5417
5418 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5419 @section The Property API
5420 @cindex properties, API
5421 @cindex API, for properties
5422
5423 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5424 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5425 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5426 property API}.
5427
5428 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5429 @chapter Dates and times
5430 @cindex dates
5431 @cindex times
5432 @cindex timestamp
5433 @cindex date stamp
5434
5435 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5436 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5437 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5438 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5439 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5440 is used in a much wider sense.
5441
5442 @menu
5443 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5444 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5445 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5446 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5447 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5448 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5449 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5450 @end menu
5451
5452
5453 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5454 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5455 @cindex timestamps
5456 @cindex ranges, time
5457 @cindex date stamps
5458 @cindex deadlines
5459 @cindex scheduling
5460
5461 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5462 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5463 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5464 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5465 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5466 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5467 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5468 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5469 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5470 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5471
5472 @table @var
5473 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5474 @cindex timestamp
5475 @cindex appointment
5476 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5477 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5478 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5479 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5480
5481 @example
5482 * Meet Peter at the movies
5483 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5484 * Discussion on climate change
5485 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5486 @end example
5487
5488 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5489 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5490 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5491 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5492 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5493 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5494
5495 @example
5496 * Pick up Sam at school
5497 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5498 @end example
5499
5500 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5501 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5502 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5503 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5504 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5505 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5506 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5507 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5508 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5509 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5510 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5511 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5512 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5513 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5514 example with optional time
5515
5516 @example
5517 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5518 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5519 @end example
5520
5521 @item Time/Date range
5522 @cindex timerange
5523 @cindex date range
5524 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5525 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5526 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5527
5528 @example
5529 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5530 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5531 @end example
5532
5533 @item Inactive timestamp
5534 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5535 @cindex inactive timestamp
5536 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5537 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5538 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5539
5540 @example
5541 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5542 [2006-11-01 Wed]
5543 @end example
5544
5545 @end table
5546
5547 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5548 @section Creating timestamps
5549 @cindex creating timestamps
5550 @cindex timestamps, creating
5551
5552 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5553 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5554 format.
5555
5556 @table @kbd
5557 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5558 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5559 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5560 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5561 succession, a time range is inserted.
5562 @c
5563 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5564 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5565 an agenda entry.
5566 @c
5567 @kindex C-u C-c .
5568 @kindex C-u C-c !
5569 @item C-u C-c .
5570 @itemx C-u C-c !
5571 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5572 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5573 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5574 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5575 @c
5576 @orgkey{C-c C-c}
5577 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5578 @c
5579 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5580 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5581 @c
5582 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5583 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5584 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5585 instead.
5586 @c
5587 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5588 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5589 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5590 @c
5591 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5592 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5593 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5594 @c
5595 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5596 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5597 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5598 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5599 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5600 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5601 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5602 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5603 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5604 @c
5605 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5606 @cindex evaluate time range
5607 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5608 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5609 the following column).
5610 @end table
5611
5612
5613 @menu
5614 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5615 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5616 @end menu
5617
5618 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5619 @subsection The date/time prompt
5620 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5621 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5622
5623 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5624 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5625 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5626 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5627 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5628 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5629 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5630 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5631 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5632 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5633 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5634 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5635 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5636 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5637 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5638 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5639 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5640 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5641
5642 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5643 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5644 in @b{bold}.
5645
5646 @example
5647 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5648 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5649 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5650 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5651 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5652 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5653 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5654 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5655 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5656 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5657 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5658 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5659 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5660 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5661 @end example
5662
5663 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5664 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5665 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5666 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5667 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5668 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5669 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5670
5671 @example
5672 +0 @result{} today
5673 . @result{} today
5674 +4d @result{} four days from today
5675 +4 @result{} same as above
5676 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5677 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5678 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5679 @end example
5680
5681 @vindex parse-time-months
5682 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5683 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5684 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5685 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5686
5687 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5688 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5689 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5690 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5691 read the docstring of the variable
5692 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5693
5694 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5695 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5696 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5697 case, e.g.:
5698
5699 @example
5700 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5701 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5702 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5703 @end example
5704
5705 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5706 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5707 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5708 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5709 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5710 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5711 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5712 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5713 from the minibuffer:
5714
5715 @kindex <
5716 @kindex >
5717 @kindex M-v
5718 @kindex C-v
5719 @kindex mouse-1
5720 @kindex S-@key{right}
5721 @kindex S-@key{left}
5722 @kindex S-@key{down}
5723 @kindex S-@key{up}
5724 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5725 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5726 @kindex @key{RET}
5727 @example
5728 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5729 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5730 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5731 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5732 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5733 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5734 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5735 @end example
5736
5737 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5738 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5739 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5740 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5741 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5742 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5743 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5744
5745 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5746 @subsection Custom time format
5747 @cindex custom date/time format
5748 @cindex time format, custom
5749 @cindex date format, custom
5750
5751 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5752 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5753 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5754 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5755 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5756 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5757 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5758
5759 @table @kbd
5760 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5761 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5762 @end table
5763
5764 @noindent
5765 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5766 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5767 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5768 following consequences:
5769 @itemize @bullet
5770 @item
5771 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5772 after.
5773 @item
5774 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5775 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5776 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5777 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5778 time will be changed by one minute.
5779 @item
5780 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5781 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5782 @item
5783 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5784 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5785 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5786 @item
5787 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5788 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5789 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5790 @end itemize
5791
5792
5793 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5794 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5795
5796 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5797
5798 @table @var
5799 @item DEADLINE
5800 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5801
5802 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5803 to be finished on that date.
5804
5805 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5806 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5807 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5808 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5809 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5810 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5811
5812 @example
5813 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5814 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5815 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5816 @end example
5817
5818 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5819 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5820 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5821
5822 @item SCHEDULED
5823 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5824
5825 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5826 date.
5827
5828 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5829 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5830 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5831 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5832 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5833 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5834 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5835
5836 @example
5837 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5838 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5839 @end example
5840
5841 @noindent
5842 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5843 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5844 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5845 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5846 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5847 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5848 want to start working on an action item.
5849 @end table
5850
5851 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5852 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5853 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5854 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5855 @c
5856 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5857 @c
5858 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5859 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5860 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5861 sexp entry matches.
5862
5863 @menu
5864 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5865 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5866 @end menu
5867
5868 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5869 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5870
5871 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5872 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5873 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5874 an item:
5875
5876 @table @kbd
5877 @c
5878 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5879 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5880 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5881 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5882 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5883 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5884 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5885 deadline.
5886
5887 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5888 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5889 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5890 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5891 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5892 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5893 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5894 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5895 scheduling time.
5896 @c
5897 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5898 @kindex k a
5899 @kindex k s
5900 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5901 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5902 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5903 schedule the marked item.
5904 @c
5905 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5906 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5907 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5908 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5909 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5910 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5911 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5912 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5913 @c
5914 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5915 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5916 @c
5917 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5918 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5919 @end table
5920
5921 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5922 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5923 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5924 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5925
5926 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5927 @subsection Repeated tasks
5928 @cindex tasks, repeated
5929 @cindex repeated tasks
5930
5931 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5932 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5933 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5934 @example
5935 ** TODO Pay the rent
5936 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5937 @end example
5938 @noindent
5939 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5940 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5941 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5942 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5943 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5944 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5945
5946 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5947 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5948 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5949 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5950 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5951 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5952 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5953 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5954 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5955 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5956 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5957 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5958 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5959 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5960 switch the date like this:
5961
5962 @example
5963 ** TODO Pay the rent
5964 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5965 @end example
5966
5967 @vindex org-log-repeat
5968 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5969 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5970 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5971 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5972 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5973
5974 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5975 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5976 will be visible.
5977
5978 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5979 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5980 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5981 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5982 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5983 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5984 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5985 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5986 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5987
5988 @example
5989 ** TODO Call Father
5990 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5991 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5992 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5993 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5994 and marked it done on Saturday.
5995 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5996 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5997 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5998 today.
5999 @end example
6000
6001 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
6002 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
6003
6004 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6005 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6006 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6007
6008
6009 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6010 @section Clocking work time
6011 @cindex clocking time
6012 @cindex time clocking
6013
6014 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6015 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6016 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6017 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6018 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6019 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6020 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6021 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6022 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6023
6024 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6025 @lisp
6026 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6027 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6028 @end lisp
6029 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6030 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6031 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6032 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6033 what to do with it.
6034
6035 @menu
6036 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6037 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6038 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6039 @end menu
6040
6041 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6042 @subsection Clocking commands
6043
6044 @table @kbd
6045 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6046 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6047 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6048 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6049 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6050 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6051 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6052 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6053 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6054 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6055 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6056 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6057 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6058 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6059 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6060 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6061 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6062 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6063 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6064 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6065 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6066 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6067 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6068 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6069 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6070 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6071 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6072 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6073 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6074 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6075 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6076 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6077 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6078 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6079 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6080 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6081 @c
6082 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6083 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6084 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6085 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6086 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6087 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6088 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6089 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6090 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6091 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6092 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6093 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6094 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6095 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6096 stopped.
6097 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6098 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6099 @kindex C-c C-y
6100 @kindex C-c C-c
6101 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6102 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6103 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6104 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6105 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6106 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6107 clock duration keeps the same.
6108 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6109 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6110 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6111 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6112 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6113 increased by five minutes.
6114 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6115 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6116 if it is running in this same item.
6117 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6118 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6119 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6120 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6121 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6122 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6123 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6124 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6125 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6126 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6127 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6128 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6129 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6130 @kbd{C-c C-c}.
6131 @end table
6132
6133 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6134 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6135 worked on or closed during a day.
6136
6137 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6138 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6139 modify the window disposition.
6140
6141 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6142 @subsection The clock table
6143 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6144 @cindex report, of clocked time
6145
6146 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6147 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6148 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6149
6150 @table @kbd
6151 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6152 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6153 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6154 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6155 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6156 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6157 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6158 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6159 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6160 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6161 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6162 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6163 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6164 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6165 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6166 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6167 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6168 @end table
6169
6170
6171 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6172 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6173
6174 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6175 @example
6176 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6177 #+END: clocktable
6178 @end example
6179 @noindent
6180 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6181 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6182 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6183 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6184
6185 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6186 be selected:
6187 @example
6188 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6189 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6190 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6191 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6192 file @r{the full current buffer}
6193 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6194 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6195 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6196 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6197 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6198 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6199 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6200 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6201 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6202 @r{these formats:}
6203 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6204 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6205 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6206 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6207 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6208 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6209 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6210 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6211 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6212 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6213 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6214 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6215 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6216 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6217 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6218 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6219 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6220 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6221 @end example
6222
6223 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6224 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6225 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6226 @example
6227 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6228 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6229 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6230 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6231 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6232 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6233 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6234 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6235 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6236 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6237 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6238 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6239 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6240 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6241 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6242 @r{property will get its own column.}
6243 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6244 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6245 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6246 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6247 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6248 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6249 @end example
6250 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6251 day, you could write
6252 @example
6253 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6254 #+END: clocktable
6255 @end example
6256 @noindent
6257 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6258 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6259 only to fit it into the manual.}
6260 @example
6261 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6262 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6263 #+END: clocktable
6264 @end example
6265 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6266 @example
6267 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6268 #+END: clocktable
6269 @end example
6270 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6271 would be
6272 @example
6273 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6274 #+END: clocktable
6275 @end example
6276
6277 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6278 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6279
6280 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6281 @cindex resolve idle time
6282
6283 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6284 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6285 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6286 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6287 applying it to another one.
6288
6289 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6290 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6291 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6292 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6293 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6294 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6295 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6296 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6297 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6298 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6299 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6300 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6301
6302 @table @kbd
6303 @item k
6304 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6305 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6306 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6307 @item K
6308 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6309 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6310 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6311 @item s
6312 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6313 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6314 @item S
6315 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6316 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6317 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6318 @item C
6319 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6320 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6321 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6322 log with an empty entry.
6323 @end table
6324
6325 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6326 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6327 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6328 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6329 the next task you clock in on.
6330
6331 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6332 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6333 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6334 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6335 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6336
6337 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6338 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6339 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6340 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6341 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6342 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6343
6344 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6345 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6346
6347 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6348 @cindex continuous clocking
6349 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6350
6351 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6352 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6353 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6354 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6355
6356 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6357 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6358
6359 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6360 @section Effort estimates
6361 @cindex effort estimates
6362
6363 @cindex property, Effort
6364 @vindex org-effort-property
6365 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6366 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6367 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6368 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6369 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6370 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6371 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6372 for an entry with the following commands:
6373
6374 @table @kbd
6375 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6376 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6377 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6378 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6379 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6380 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6381 @end table
6382
6383 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6384 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6385 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6386 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6387 buffer you can use
6388
6389 @example
6390 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6391 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6392 @end example
6393
6394 @noindent
6395 @vindex org-global-properties
6396 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6397 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6398 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6399 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6400 setup may be advised.
6401
6402 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6403 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6404 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6405 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6406
6407 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6408 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6409 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6410 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6411 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6412 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6413 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6414 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6415 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6416
6417 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6418 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6419 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6420 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6421
6422 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6423 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6424 @cindex relative timer
6425
6426 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6427 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6428 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6429
6430 @table @kbd
6431 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6432 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6433 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6434 restarted.
6435 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6436 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6437 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6438 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6439 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6440 new timer items.
6441 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6442 @kindex C-c C-x ,
6443 @item C-c C-x ,
6444 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6445 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6446 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6447 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6448 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
6449 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6450 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6451 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6452 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6453 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6454 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6455 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6456 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6457 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6458 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6459 not started at exactly the right moment.
6460 @end table
6461
6462 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6463 @section Countdown timer
6464 @cindex Countdown timer
6465 @kindex C-c C-x ;
6466 @kindex ;
6467
6468 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6469 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6470
6471 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6472 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6473 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6474 default value.
6475
6476 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6477 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6478 @cindex capture
6479
6480 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6481 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6482 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6483 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6484 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6485 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6486
6487 @menu
6488 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6489 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6490 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6491 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6492 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6493 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6494 @end menu
6495
6496 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6497 @section Capture
6498 @cindex capture
6499
6500 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6501 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6502 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6503 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6504 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6505
6506 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6507 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6508 @example
6509 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6510 @end example
6511 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6512 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6513 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6514 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6515
6516 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6517 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6518 does enhance it with templates and more.
6519
6520 @menu
6521 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6522 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6523 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6524 @end menu
6525
6526 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6527 @subsection Setting up capture
6528
6529 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6530 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6531 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6532
6533 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6534 @example
6535 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6536 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6537 @end example
6538
6539 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6540 @subsection Using capture
6541
6542 @table @kbd
6543 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6544 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6545 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6546 @cindex date tree
6547 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6548 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6549 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6550 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6551
6552 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6553 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6554 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6555 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6556 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6557
6558 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6559 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6560 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6561 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6562 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6563 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6564 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6565
6566 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6567 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6568
6569 @end table
6570
6571 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6572 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6573 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6574 rather than to the current date.
6575
6576 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6577 prefix commands:
6578
6579 @table @kbd
6580 @orgkey{C-u C-c c}
6581 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6582 template in the usual way.
6583 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6584 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6585 @end table
6586
6587 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6588 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6589 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6590 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6591 @code{nil}.
6592
6593 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6594 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6595
6596 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6597 @subsection Capture templates
6598 @cindex templates, for Capture
6599
6600 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6601 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6602 through the customize interface.
6603
6604 @table @kbd
6605 @orgkey{C-c c C}
6606 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6607 @end table
6608
6609 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6610 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6611 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6612 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6613 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6614 would look like:
6615
6616 @example
6617 (setq org-capture-templates
6618 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6619 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6620 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6621 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6622 @end example
6623
6624 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6625 for you like this:
6626 @example
6627 * TODO
6628 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6629 @end example
6630
6631 @noindent
6632 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6633 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6634 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6635 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6636 place where you started the capture process.
6637
6638 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6639 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6640 like this:
6641
6642 @lisp
6643 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6644 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6645 @end lisp
6646
6647 @menu
6648 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6649 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6650 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6651 @end menu
6652
6653 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6654 @subsubsection Template elements
6655
6656 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6657 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6658
6659 @table @var
6660 @item keys
6661 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6662 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6663 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6664 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6665 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6666 prefix key, for example
6667 @example
6668 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6669 @end example
6670 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6671 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6672
6673 @item description
6674 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6675 selection.
6676
6677 @item type
6678 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6679 @table @code
6680 @item entry
6681 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6682 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6683 @item item
6684 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6685 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6686 @item checkitem
6687 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6688 default template.
6689 @item table-line
6690 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6691 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6692 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6693 @item plain
6694 Text to be inserted as it is.
6695 @end table
6696
6697 @item target
6698 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6699 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6700 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6701 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6702 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6703 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6704 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6705
6706 Valid values are:
6707 @table @code
6708 @item (file "path/to/file")
6709 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6710
6711 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6712 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6713
6714 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6715 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6716
6717 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6718 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6719
6720 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6721 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6722
6723 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6724 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6725
6726 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6727 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6728
6729 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6730 A function to find the right location in the file.
6731
6732 @item (clock)
6733 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6734
6735 @item (function function-finding-location)
6736 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6737 file and location.
6738 @end table
6739
6740 @item template
6741 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6742 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6743 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6744 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6745 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6746 more details.
6747
6748 @item properties
6749 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6750 Recognized properties are:
6751 @table @code
6752 @item :prepend
6753 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6754 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6755 Setting this property will change that.
6756
6757 @item :immediate-finish
6758 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6759 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6760 information that can be added automatically.
6761
6762 @item :empty-lines
6763 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6764 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6765
6766 @item :clock-in
6767 Start the clock in this item.
6768
6769 @item :clock-keep
6770 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6771
6772 @item :clock-resume
6773 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6774 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6775 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6776 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6777
6778 @item :unnarrowed
6779 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6780 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6781
6782 @item :table-line-pos
6783 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6784 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6785 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6786 line.
6787
6788 @item :kill-buffer
6789 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6790 buffer again after capture is completed.
6791 @end table
6792 @end table
6793
6794 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6795 @subsubsection Template expansion
6796
6797 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6798 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6799 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6800
6801 @smallexample
6802 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6803 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6804 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6805 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6806 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6807 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6808 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6809 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6810 @r{region is active.}
6811 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6812 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6813 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6814 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6815 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6816 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6817 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6818 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6819 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6820 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6821 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6822 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6823 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6824 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6825 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6826 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6827 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6828 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6829 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6830 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6831 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6832 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6833 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6834 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6835 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6836 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6837 @end smallexample
6838
6839 @noindent
6840 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6841 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6842 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6843 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6844 similar way.}:
6845
6846 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6847 @smallexample
6848 Link type | Available keywords
6849 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6850 bbdb | %:name %:company
6851 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6852 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6853 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6854 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6855 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6856 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6857 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6858 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6859 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6860 w3, w3m | %:url
6861 info | %:file %:node
6862 calendar | %:date
6863 @end smallexample
6864
6865 @noindent
6866 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6867
6868 @smallexample
6869 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6870 @end smallexample
6871
6872 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6873 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6874
6875 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6876 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6877 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6878 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6879 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6880
6881 @example
6882 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6883 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6884 @end example
6885
6886 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6887 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6888
6889 @example
6890 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6891 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6892 @end example
6893
6894 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6895
6896 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6897 @section Attachments
6898 @cindex attachments
6899
6900 @vindex org-attach-directory
6901 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6902 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6903 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6904 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6905 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6906 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6907 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6908 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6909 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6910 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6911 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6912 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6913 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6914
6915 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6916 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6917 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6918 directory.
6919
6920 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6921
6922 @table @kbd
6923
6924 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6925 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6926 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6927 to select a command:
6928
6929 @table @kbd
6930 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6931 @vindex org-attach-method
6932 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6933 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6934 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6935
6936 @kindex C-c C-a c
6937 @kindex C-c C-a m
6938 @kindex C-c C-a l
6939 @item c/m/l
6940 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6941 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6942
6943 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6944 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6945
6946 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6947 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6948 attachments yourself.
6949
6950 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6951 @vindex org-file-apps
6952 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6953 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6954 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6955 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6956
6957 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6958 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6959
6960 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6961 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6962
6963 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6964 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6965
6966 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6967 Select and delete a single attachment.
6968
6969 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6970 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6971 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6972
6973 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6974 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6975 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6976 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6977
6978 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6979 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6980 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6981 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6982 @end table
6983 @end table
6984
6985 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6986 @section RSS feeds
6987 @cindex RSS feeds
6988 @cindex Atom feeds
6989
6990 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6991 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6992 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6993 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6994 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6995 information. Here is just an example:
6996
6997 @example
6998 (setq org-feed-alist
6999 '(("Slashdot"
7000 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7001 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7002 @end example
7003
7004 @noindent
7005 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7006 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7007 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7008 the following command is used:
7009
7010 @table @kbd
7011 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7012 @item C-c C-x g
7013 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7014 them.
7015 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7016 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7017 @end table
7018
7019 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7020 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7021 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7022 list of drawers in that file:
7023
7024 @example
7025 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7026 @end example
7027
7028 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7029 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7030
7031 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7032 @section Protocols for external access
7033 @cindex protocols, for external access
7034 @cindex emacsserver
7035
7036 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7037 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7038 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7039 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7040 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7041 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7042 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7043 documentation and setup instructions.
7044
7045 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7046 @section Refiling notes
7047 @cindex refiling notes
7048
7049 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7050 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7051 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7052 process, you can use the following special command:
7053
7054 @table @kbd
7055 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7056 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7057 @vindex org-refile-targets
7058 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7059 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7060 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7061 @vindex org-log-refile
7062 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7063 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7064 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7065 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7066 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7067 last subitem.@*
7068 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7069 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7070 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7071 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7072 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7073 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7074 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7075 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7076 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7077 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7078 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7079 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7080 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7081 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7082 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7083 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7084 @item C-2 C-c C-w
7085 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7086 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7087 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7088 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7089 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7090 @end table
7091
7092 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7093 @section Archiving
7094 @cindex archiving
7095
7096 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7097 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7098 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7099 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7100
7101 @table @kbd
7102 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7103 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7104 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7105 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7106 @end table
7107
7108 @menu
7109 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7110 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7111 @end menu
7112
7113 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7114 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7115 @cindex external archiving
7116
7117 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7118 the archive file.
7119
7120 @table @kbd
7121 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7122 @vindex org-archive-location
7123 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7124 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7125 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7126 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7127 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7128 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7129 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7130 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7131 @end table
7132
7133 @cindex archive locations
7134 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7135 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7136 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7137 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7138 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7139 see the documentation string of the variable
7140 @code{org-archive-location}.
7141
7142 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7143 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7144 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7145 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7146 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7147 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7148 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7149 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7150
7151 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
7152 @example
7153 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7154 @end example
7155
7156 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7157 @noindent
7158 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7159 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7160 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7161
7162 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7163 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7164 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7165 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7166 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7167 added.
7168
7169
7170 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7171 @subsection Internal archiving
7172
7173 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7174 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7175
7176 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7177 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7178 @itemize @minus
7179 @item
7180 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7181 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7182 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7183 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7184 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7185 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7186 @item
7187 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7188 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7189 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7190 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7191 @item
7192 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7193 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7194 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7195 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7196 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7197 temporarily included.
7198 @item
7199 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7200 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7201 is. Configure the details using the variable
7202 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7203 @item
7204 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7205 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7206 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7207 @end itemize
7208
7209 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7210
7211 @table @kbd
7212 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7213 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7214 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7215 hidden.
7216 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7217 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7218 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7219 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7220 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7221 level 1 trees will be checked.
7222 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7223 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7224 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7225 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7226 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7227 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7228 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7229 outline.
7230 @end table
7231
7232
7233 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7234 @chapter Agenda views
7235 @cindex agenda views
7236
7237 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7238 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7239 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7240 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7241 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7242
7243 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7244 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7245
7246 @itemize @bullet
7247 @item
7248 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7249 for specific dates,
7250 @item
7251 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7252 action items,
7253 @item
7254 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7255 TODO state associated with them,
7256 @item
7257 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7258 in time-sorted view,
7259 @item
7260 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7261 that contain specified keywords,
7262 @item
7263 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7264 along, and
7265 @item
7266 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7267 views.
7268 @end itemize
7269
7270 @noindent
7271 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7272 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7273 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7274 edit these files remotely.
7275
7276 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7277 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7278 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7279 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7280 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7281 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7282
7283 @menu
7284 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7285 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7286 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7287 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7288 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7289 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7290 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7291 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7292 @end menu
7293
7294 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7295 @section Agenda files
7296 @cindex agenda files
7297 @cindex files for agenda
7298
7299 @vindex org-agenda-files
7300 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7301 files}, the files listed in the variable
7302 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7303 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7304 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7305 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7306 of the list.
7307
7308 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7309 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7310 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7311 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7312 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7313 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7314
7315 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7316 @table @kbd
7317 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7318 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7319 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7320 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7321 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7322 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7323 @kindex C-,
7324 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7325 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7326 @itemx C-,
7327 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7328 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7329 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7330 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7331 buffers.
7332 @end table
7333
7334 @noindent
7335 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7336 to visit any of them.
7337
7338 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7339 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7340 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7341 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7342 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7343 extended period, use the following commands:
7344
7345 @table @kbd
7346 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7347 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7348 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7349 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7350 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7351 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7352 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7353 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7354 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7355 @end table
7356
7357 @noindent
7358 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7359 the Speedbar frame:
7360 @table @kbd
7361 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7362 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7363 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7364 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7365 effect immediately.
7366 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7367 Lift the restriction.
7368 @end table
7369
7370 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7371 @section The agenda dispatcher
7372 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7373 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7374 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7375 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7376 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7377 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7378 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7379 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7380 @table @kbd
7381 @item a
7382 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7383 @item t @r{/} T
7384 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7385 @item m @r{/} M
7386 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7387 tags and properties}).
7388 @item L
7389 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7390 @item s
7391 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7392 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7393 @item /
7394 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7395 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7396 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7397 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7398 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7399 1.
7400 @item # @r{/} !
7401 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7402 @item <
7403 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7404 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7405 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7406 selecting the command.
7407 @item < <
7408 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7409 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7410 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7411 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7412 character selecting the command.
7413
7414 @item *
7415 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7416 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7417 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7418 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7419 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7420 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7421 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7422 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7423 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7424 @end table
7425
7426 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7427 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7428 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7429 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7430 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7431
7432 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7433 @section The built-in agenda views
7434
7435 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7436
7437 @menu
7438 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7439 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7440 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7441 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7442 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7443 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7444 @end menu
7445
7446 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7447 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7448 @cindex agenda
7449 @cindex weekly agenda
7450 @cindex daily agenda
7451
7452 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7453 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7454
7455 @table @kbd
7456 @cindex org-agenda, command
7457 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7458 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7459 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7460 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7461 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7462 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7463 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @vindex org-agenda-span
7467 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7468 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7469 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7470 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7471 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7472 @code{year}.
7473
7474 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7475 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7476 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7477 commands}.
7478
7479 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7480 @cindex calendar integration
7481 @cindex diary integration
7482
7483 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7484 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7485 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7486 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7487 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7488 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7489 the diary.
7490
7491 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7492 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7493
7494 @lisp
7495 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7496 @end lisp
7497
7498 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7499 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7500 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7501 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7502 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7503 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7504 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7505 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7506 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7507 between calendar and agenda.
7508
7509 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7510 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7511 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7512 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7513 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7514 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7515 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7516 will be made in the agenda:
7517
7518 @example
7519 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7520 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
7521 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7522 #+CATEGORY: Ann
7523 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7524 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7525 @end example
7526
7527 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7528 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7529 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7530
7531 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7532 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7533 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7534 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7535 following to one of your agenda files:
7536
7537 @example
7538 * Anniversaries
7539 :PROPERTIES:
7540 :CATEGORY: Anniv
7541 :END:
7542 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7543 @end example
7544
7545 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7546 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7547 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7548 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7549 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7550 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7551 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7552
7553 @example
7554 1973-06-22
7555 06-22
7556 1955-08-02 wedding
7557 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7558 @end example
7559
7560 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7561 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7562 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7563 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7564 in an Org or Diary file.
7565
7566 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7567 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7568 @cindex appointment reminders
7569 @cindex appointment
7570 @cindex reminders
7571
7572 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7573 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7574 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7575 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7576 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7577 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7578 docstring for details.
7579
7580 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7581 @subsection The global TODO list
7582 @cindex global TODO list
7583 @cindex TODO list, global
7584
7585 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7586 collected into a single place.
7587
7588 @table @kbd
7589 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7590 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7591 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7592 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7593 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7594 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7595 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7596 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7597 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7598 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7599 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7600 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7601 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7602 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7603 @kindex r
7604 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7605 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7606 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7607 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7608 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7609 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7610 @end table
7611
7612 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7613 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7614 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7615
7616 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7617 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7618 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7619 it more compact:
7620 @itemize @minus
7621 @item
7622 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7623 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7624 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7625 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7626 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7627 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7628 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7629 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7630 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7631 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7632 TODO list.
7633 @item
7634 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7635 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7636 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7637 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7638 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7639 @end itemize
7640
7641 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7642 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7643 @cindex matching, of tags
7644 @cindex matching, of properties
7645 @cindex tags view
7646 @cindex match view
7647
7648 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7649 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7650 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7651 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7652 m}.
7653
7654 @table @kbd
7655 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7656 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7657 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7658 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7659 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7660 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7661 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7662 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7663 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7664 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7665 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7666 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7667 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7668 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7669 @ref{Tag searches}.
7670 @end table
7671
7672 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7673 commands}.
7674
7675 @subsubheading Match syntax
7676
7677 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7678 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7679 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7680 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7681 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7682 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7683 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7684 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7685 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7686
7687 @table @samp
7688 @item +work-boss
7689 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7690 @samp{:boss:}.
7691 @item work|laptop
7692 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7693 @item work|laptop+night
7694 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7695 @samp{:night:}.
7696 @end table
7697
7698 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7699 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7700 braces. For example,
7701 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7702 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7703
7704 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7705 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7706 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7707 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7708 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7709 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7710 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7711 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7712 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7713 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7714 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7715 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7716 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7717 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7718 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7719 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7720
7721 Here are more examples:
7722 @table @samp
7723 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7724 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7725 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7726 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7727 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7728 @end table
7729
7730 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7731 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7732
7733 @example
7734 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7735 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7736 @end example
7737
7738 @noindent
7739 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7740 @itemize @minus
7741 @item
7742 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7743 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7744 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7745 @item
7746 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7747 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7748 @item
7749 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7750 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7751 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7752 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7753 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7754 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7755 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7756 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7757 respectively, can be used.
7758 @item
7759 If the comparison value is enclosed
7760 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7761 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7762 match.
7763 @end itemize
7764
7765 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7766 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7767 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7768 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7769 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7770 on or after October 11, 2008.
7771
7772 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7773 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7774 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7775 again.
7776
7777 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7778 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7779 inheritance}, for details.
7780
7781 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7782 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7783 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7784 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7785 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7786 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7787 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7788 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7789 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7790 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7791 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7792 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7793
7794 @table @samp
7795 @item work/WAITING
7796 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7797 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7798 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7799 nor @samp{NEXT}
7800 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7801 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7802 @samp{NEXT}.
7803 @end table
7804
7805 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7806 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7807 @cindex timeline, single file
7808 @cindex time-sorted view
7809
7810 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7811 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7812 to give an overview over events in a project.
7813
7814 @table @kbd
7815 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7816 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7817 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7818 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7819 @end table
7820
7821 @noindent
7822 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7823 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7824
7825 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7826 @subsection Search view
7827 @cindex search view
7828 @cindex text search
7829 @cindex searching, for text
7830
7831 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7832 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7833
7834 @table @kbd
7835 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7836 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7837 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7838 @end table
7839 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7840 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7841 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7842 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7843 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7844 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7845 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7846 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7847 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7848 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7849 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7850
7851 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7852 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7853 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7854
7855 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7856 @subsection Stuck projects
7857 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7858
7859 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7860 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7861 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7862 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7863 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7864 projects and define next actions for them.
7865
7866 @table @kbd
7867 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7868 List projects that are stuck.
7869 @kindex C-c a !
7870 @item C-c a !
7871 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7872 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7873 project is and how to find it.
7874 @end table
7875
7876 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7877 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7878 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7879 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7880
7881 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7882 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7883 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7884 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7885 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7886 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7887 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7888 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7889 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7890 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7891 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7892 correct customization for this is
7893
7894 @lisp
7895 (setq org-stuck-projects
7896 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7897 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7898 @end lisp
7899
7900 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7901 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7902
7903 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7904 @section Presentation and sorting
7905 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7906
7907 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7908 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7909 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7910 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7911 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7912 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7913 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7914 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7915 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7916 associated with the item.
7917
7918 @menu
7919 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7920 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7921 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7922 @end menu
7923
7924 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7925 @subsection Categories
7926
7927 @cindex category
7928 @cindex #+CATEGORY
7929 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7930 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7931 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7932 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7933 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7934 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7935 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7936 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7937 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7938 property.}:
7939
7940 @example
7941 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7942 @end example
7943
7944 @noindent
7945 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7946 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7947 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7948 special category you want to apply as the value.
7949
7950 @noindent
7951 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7952 longer than 10 characters.
7953
7954 @noindent
7955 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7956 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7957
7958 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7959 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7960 @cindex time-of-day specification
7961
7962 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7963 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7964 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7965 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7966 @c
7967 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7968
7969 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7970 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7971 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7972 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7973
7974 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7975 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7976 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7977
7978 @example
7979 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7980 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7981 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7982 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7983 @end example
7984
7985 @cindex time grid
7986 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7987 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7988
7989 @example
7990 8:00...... ------------------
7991 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7992 10:00...... ------------------
7993 12:00...... ------------------
7994 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7995 14:00...... ------------------
7996 16:00...... ------------------
7997 18:00...... ------------------
7998 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7999 20:00...... ------------------
8000 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8001 @end example
8002
8003 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8004 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8005 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8006 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8007 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8008
8009 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8010 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
8011 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8012 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8013 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8014 done depends on the type of view.
8015 @itemize @bullet
8016 @item
8017 @vindex org-agenda-files
8018 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8019 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8020 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8021 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8022 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8023 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8024 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8025 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8026 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8027 @item
8028 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8029 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8030 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8031 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8032 or scheduled date.
8033 @item
8034 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8035 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8036 @end itemize
8037
8038 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8039 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8040 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8041 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8042
8043 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8044 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8045 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8046
8047 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8048 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8049 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8050 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8051 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8052 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8053
8054 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8055 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8056
8057 @table @kbd
8058 @tsubheading{Motion}
8059 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8060 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8061 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8062 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8063 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8064 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8065 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8066 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8067 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8068 outline, not only the heading.
8069 @c
8070 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8071 Display original location and recenter that window.
8072 @c
8073 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8074 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8075 @c
8076 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8077 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8078 @c
8079 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8080 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8081 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8082 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8083 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8084 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8085 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8086 @c
8087 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8088 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8089 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8090 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8091 previously used indirect buffer.
8092
8093 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8094 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8095 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8096 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8097
8098 @tsubheading{Change display}
8099 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8100 @kindex A
8101 @item A
8102 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8103 @c
8104 @kindex o
8105 @item o
8106 Delete other windows.
8107 @c
8108 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8109 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8110 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8111 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8112 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8113 @vindex org-agenda-span
8114 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8115 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8116 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8117 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8118 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8119 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8120 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8121 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8122 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8123 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8124 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8125 @c
8126 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8127 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8128 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8129 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8130 @c
8131 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8132 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8133 @c
8134 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8135 Go to today.
8136 @c
8137 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8138 Prompt for a date and go there.
8139 @c
8140 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8141 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8142 @c
8143 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8144 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8145 @c
8146 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8147 @kindex v L
8148 @vindex org-log-done
8149 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8150 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8151 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8152 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8153 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8154 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8155 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8156 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8157 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8158 @c
8159 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8160 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8161 agenda and timeline views.
8162 @c
8163 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8164 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8165 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8166 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8167 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8168 press @kbd{v a} again.
8169 @c
8170 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8171 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8172 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8173 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8174 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8175 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8176 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8177 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8178 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8179 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8180 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8181 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8182 @c
8183 @orgkey{v c}
8184 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8185 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8186 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8187 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8188 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8189 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8190 mode.
8191 @c
8192 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8193 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8194 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8195 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8196 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8197 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8198 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8199 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8200 @c
8201 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8202 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8203 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8204 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8205 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8206 @c
8207 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8208 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8209 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8210 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8211 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8212 keyword.
8213 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8214 Same as @kbd{r}.
8215 @c
8216 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8217 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8218 IDs.
8219 @c
8220 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8221 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8222 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8223 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8224 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8225 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8226 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8227 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8228
8229 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8230 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8231 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8232
8233 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8234 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8235 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8236 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8237 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8238 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8239
8240 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8241 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8242
8243 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8244 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8245 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8246 (see below.)
8247
8248 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8249 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8250 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8251 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8252 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8253 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8254 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8255 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8256 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8257 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8258 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8259
8260 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8261 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8262 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8263 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8264 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8265 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8266 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8267 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8268 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8269 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8270
8271 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8272 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8273 efforts globally, for example
8274 @lisp
8275 (setq org-global-properties
8276 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8277 @end lisp
8278 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8279 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8280 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8281 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8282 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8283 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8284 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8285 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8286 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8287 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8288
8289 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8290 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8291 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8292 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8293 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8294 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8295 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8296 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8297 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8298
8299 @lisp
8300 @group
8301 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8302 (and (cond
8303 ((string= tag "Net")
8304 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8305 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8306 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8307 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8308 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8309 (concat "-" tag)))
8310
8311 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8312 @end group
8313 @end lisp
8314
8315 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8316 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8317 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8318 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8319 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8320
8321 @c
8322 @kindex [
8323 @kindex ]
8324 @kindex @{
8325 @kindex @}
8326 @item [ ] @{ @}
8327 @table @i
8328 @item @r{in} search view
8329 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8330 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8331 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8332 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8333 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8334 selected.
8335 @end table
8336
8337 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8338 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8339
8340 @item 0-9
8341 Digit argument.
8342 @c
8343 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8344 @cindex remote editing, undo
8345 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8346 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8347 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8348 @c
8349 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8350 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8351 original org file.
8352 @c
8353 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8354 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8355 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8356 @c
8357 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8358 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8359 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8360 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8361 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8362 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8363 @c
8364 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8365 Refile the entry at point.
8366 @c
8367 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8368 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8369 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8370 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8371 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8372 @c
8373 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8374 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8375 @c
8376 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8377 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8378 sibling}.
8379 @c
8380 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8381 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8382 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8383 different file.
8384 @c
8385 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8386 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8387 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8388 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8389 tags of a headline occasionally.
8390 @c
8391 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8392 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8393 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8394 @c
8395 @kindex ,
8396 @item ,
8397 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8398 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8399 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8400 @c
8401 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8402 Display weighted priority of current item.
8403 @c
8404 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8405 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8406 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8407 key for this.
8408 @c
8409 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8410 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8411 @c
8412 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8413 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8414 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8415 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8416 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8417 @c
8418 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8419 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8420 @c
8421 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8422 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8423 @c
8424 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8425 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8426 @c
8427 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8428 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8429 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8430 it to today.@*
8431 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8432 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8433 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8434 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8435 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8436 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8437 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8438 @c
8439 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8440 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8441 into the past.
8442 @c
8443 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8444 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8445 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8446 @c
8447 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8448 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8449 is stopped first.
8450 @c
8451 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8452 Stop the previously started clock.
8453 @c
8454 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8455 Cancel the currently running clock.
8456 @c
8457 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8458 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8459 @c
8460 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8461 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8462 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8463 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8464 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8465 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8466
8467 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8468 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8469 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8470 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8471
8472 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8473 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8474 successive entries.
8475 @c
8476 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8477 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8478 @c
8479 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8480 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8481 @c
8482 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8483 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8484 @c
8485 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8486 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8487 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8488 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8489 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8490 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8491 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8492
8493 @example
8494 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8495 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8496 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8497 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8498 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8499 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8500 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8501 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8502 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8503 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8504 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8505 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8506 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8507 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8508 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8509 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8510 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8511 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8512 @r{entries to web.}
8513 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8514 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8515 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8516 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8517 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8518 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8519 @r{ (save-excursion}
8520 @r{ (save-restriction}
8521 @r{ (widen)}
8522 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8523 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8524 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8525 @end example
8526
8527
8528 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8529 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8530
8531 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8532 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8533 @c
8534 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8535 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8536 date at the cursor.
8537 @c
8538 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8539 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8540 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8541 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8542 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8543 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8544 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8545 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8546 you can add the entry.
8547
8548 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8549 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8550 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8551 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8552 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8553 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8554 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8555 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8556 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8557 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8558 @c
8559 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8560 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8561 @c
8562 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8563 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8564 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8565 @c
8566 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8567 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8568 calendars.
8569 @c
8570 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8571 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8572
8573 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8574 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8575 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8576
8577 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8578 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8579 @cindex exporting agenda views
8580 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8581 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8582 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8583 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8584 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8585 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8586 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8587 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8588 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8589
8590 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8591 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8592 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8593 @c
8594 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8595 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8596 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8597 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8598 visit Org files will not be removed.
8599 @end table
8600
8601
8602 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8603 @section Custom agenda views
8604 @cindex custom agenda views
8605 @cindex agenda views, custom
8606
8607 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8608 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8609 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8610 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8611
8612 @menu
8613 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8614 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8615 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8616 @end menu
8617
8618 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8619 @subsection Storing searches
8620
8621 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8622 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8623 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8624 buffer).
8625 @kindex C-c a C
8626 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8627
8628 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8629 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8630 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8631 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8632 types:
8633
8634 @lisp
8635 @group
8636 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8637 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8638 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8639 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8640 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8641 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8642 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8643 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8644 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8645 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8646 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8647 @end group
8648 @end lisp
8649
8650 @noindent
8651 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8652 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8653 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8654 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8655 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8656 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8657 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8658 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8659 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8660 therefore define:
8661
8662 @table @kbd
8663 @item C-c a w
8664 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8665 keyword
8666 @item C-c a W
8667 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8668 results as a sparse tree
8669 @item C-c a u
8670 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8671 @samp{:urgent:}
8672 @item C-c a v
8673 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8674 headlines that are also TODO items
8675 @item C-c a U
8676 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8677 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8678 @item C-c a f
8679 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8680 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8681 @item C-c a h
8682 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8683 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8684 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8685 @end table
8686
8687 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8688 @subsection Block agenda
8689 @cindex block agenda
8690 @cindex agenda, with block views
8691
8692 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8693 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8694 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8695 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8696 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8697 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8698 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8699
8700 @lisp
8701 @group
8702 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8703 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8704 ((agenda "")
8705 (tags-todo "home")
8706 (tags "garden")))
8707 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8708 ((agenda "")
8709 (tags-todo "work")
8710 (tags "office")))))
8711 @end group
8712 @end lisp
8713
8714 @noindent
8715 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8716 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8717 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8718 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8719 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8720
8721 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8722 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8723 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8724
8725 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8726 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8727 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8728 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8729 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8730 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8731 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8732
8733 @lisp
8734 @group
8735 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8736 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8737 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8738 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8739 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8740 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8741 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8742 ("N" search ""
8743 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8744 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8745 @end group
8746 @end lisp
8747
8748 @noindent
8749 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8750 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8751 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8752 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8753 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8754 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8755 to only a single file.
8756
8757 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8758 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8759 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8760 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8761 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8762 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8763 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8764 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8765 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8766 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8767 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8768
8769 @lisp
8770 @group
8771 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8772 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8773 ((agenda)
8774 (tags-todo "home")
8775 (tags "garden"
8776 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8777 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8778 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8779 ((agenda)
8780 (tags-todo "work")
8781 (tags "office")))))
8782 @end group
8783 @end lisp
8784
8785 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8786 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8787 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8788 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8789 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8790 yourself.
8791
8792 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8793 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8794 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8795 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8796 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8797 like this:
8798
8799 @example
8800 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8801 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8802 @end example
8803
8804 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8805 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8806
8807 @example
8808 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8809 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8810 @end example
8811
8812 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8813
8814 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8815 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8816 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8817
8818 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8819 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8820 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8821 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8822 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8823 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8824 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8825
8826 @table @kbd
8827 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8828 @cindex exporting agenda views
8829 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8830 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8831 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8832 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8833 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8834 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8835 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8836 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8837
8838 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8839 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8840 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8841 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8842 @lisp
8843 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8844 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8845 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8846 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8847 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8848 @end lisp
8849 @end table
8850
8851 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8852 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8853 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8854 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8855 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8856 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8857 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8858 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8859 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8860 or absolute.
8861
8862 @lisp
8863 @group
8864 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8865 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8866 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8867 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8868 ((agenda "")
8869 (tags-todo "home")
8870 (tags "garden"))
8871 nil
8872 ("~/views/home.html"))
8873 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8874 ((agenda)
8875 (tags-todo "work")
8876 (tags "office"))
8877 nil
8878 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8879 @end group
8880 @end lisp
8881
8882 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8883 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8884 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8885 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8886 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8887 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8888 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8889 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8890
8891 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8892 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8893 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8894 files in one step:
8895
8896 @table @kbd
8897 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8898 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8899 them.
8900 @end table
8901
8902 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8903 set options for the export commands. For example:
8904
8905 @lisp
8906 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8907 '(("X" agenda ""
8908 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8909 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8910 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8911 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8912 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8913 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8914 @end lisp
8915
8916 @noindent
8917 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8918 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8919 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8920 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8921 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8922 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8923 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8924 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8925 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8926
8927 @noindent
8928 From the command line you may also use
8929 @example
8930 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8931 @end example
8932 @noindent
8933 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8934 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8935 @example
8936 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8937 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8938 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8939 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8940 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8941 -kill
8942 @end example
8943 @noindent
8944 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8945 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8946 extent.
8947
8948 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8949 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8950 more information.
8951
8952
8953 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8954 @section Using column view in the agenda
8955 @cindex column view, in agenda
8956 @cindex agenda, column view
8957
8958 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8959 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8960 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8961 collected by certain criteria.
8962
8963 @table @kbd
8964 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8965 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8966 @end table
8967
8968 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8969 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8970 This causes the following issues:
8971
8972 @enumerate
8973 @item
8974 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8975 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8976 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8977 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8978 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8979 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8980 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8981 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8982 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8983 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8984 @item
8985 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8986 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8987 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8988 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8989 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8990 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8991 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8992 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8993 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8994 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8995 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8996 some values will count double.
8997 @item
8998 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8999 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
9000 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9001 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9002 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9003 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9004 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9005 the agenda).
9006
9007 @item
9008 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9009 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9010 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9011 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9012 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9013 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9014 @end enumerate
9015
9016
9017 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9018 @chapter Markup for rich export
9019
9020 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9021 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9022 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9023 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9024 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9025
9026 @menu
9027 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9028 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9029 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9030 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9031 * Index entries:: Making an index
9032 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9033 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9034 @end menu
9035
9036 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9037 @section Structural markup elements
9038
9039 @menu
9040 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9041 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9042 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9043 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9044 * Lists:: Lists
9045 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9046 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9047 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9048 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9049 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9050 @end menu
9051
9052 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9053 @subheading Document title
9054 @cindex document title, markup rules
9055
9056 @noindent
9057 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9058
9059 @cindex #+TITLE
9060 @example
9061 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9062 @end example
9063
9064 @noindent
9065 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9066 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9067 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9068 title will be the file name without extension.
9069
9070 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9071 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9072 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9073 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9074
9075 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9076 @subheading Headings and sections
9077 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9078
9079 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9080 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9081 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9082 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9083 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9084 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9085 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9086 per-file basis with a line
9087
9088 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9089 @example
9090 #+OPTIONS: H:4
9091 @end example
9092
9093 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9094 @subheading Table of contents
9095 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9096
9097 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9098 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9099 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9100 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9101 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9102 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9103 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9104 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9105
9106 @example
9107 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9108 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9109 @end example
9110
9111 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9112 @subheading Text before the first headline
9113 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9114 @cindex #+TEXT
9115
9116 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9117 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9118 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9119 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9120
9121 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9122 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9123 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9124 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9125 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9126 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9127
9128 @noindent
9129 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9130 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9131
9132 @example
9133 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
9134 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9135 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9136 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9137 @end example
9138
9139 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9140 @subheading Lists
9141 @cindex lists, markup rules
9142
9143 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9144 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9145 description lists.
9146
9147 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9148 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9149 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9150
9151 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9152 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9153
9154 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9155 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9156
9157 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9158 @example
9159 #+BEGIN_VERSE
9160 Great clouds overhead
9161 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9162 Snow covers Emacs
9163
9164 -- AlexSchroeder
9165 #+END_VERSE
9166 @end example
9167
9168 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9169 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9170 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9171
9172 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9173 @example
9174 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9175 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9176 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9177 #+END_QUOTE
9178 @end example
9179
9180 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9181 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9182 @example
9183 #+BEGIN_CENTER
9184 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9185 but not any simpler
9186 #+END_CENTER
9187 @end example
9188
9189
9190 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9191 @subheading Footnote markup
9192 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9193 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9194
9195 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9196 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9197 multiple footnotes side by side.
9198
9199 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9200 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9201
9202 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9203 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9204 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9205 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9206 @cindex code text, markup rules
9207 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9208 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9209 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9210 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9211 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9212
9213 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9214 @subheading Horizontal rules
9215 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9216 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9217 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9218
9219 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9220 @subheading Comment lines
9221 @cindex comment lines
9222 @cindex exporting, not
9223 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9224
9225 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by @samp{#}
9226 are treated as comments and will never be exported. Also entire subtrees
9227 starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally,
9228 regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will
9229 not be exported.
9230
9231 @table @kbd
9232 @kindex C-c ;
9233 @item C-c ;
9234 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9235 @end table
9236
9237
9238 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9239 @section Images and Tables
9240
9241 @cindex tables, markup rules
9242 @cindex #+CAPTION
9243 @cindex #+LABEL
9244 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9245 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9246 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9247 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9248 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9249 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9250
9251 @example
9252 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9253 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9254 | ... | ...|
9255 |-----|----|
9256 @end example
9257
9258 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9259 @example
9260 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9261 @end example
9262
9263 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9264 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9265 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9266 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9267 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9268 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9269 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9270
9271 @example
9272 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9273 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9274 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9275 @end example
9276
9277 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9278 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9279 information.
9280
9281 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9282
9283 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9284 @section Literal examples
9285 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9286 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9287
9288 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9289 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9290 for source code and similar examples.
9291 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9292
9293 @example
9294 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9295 Some example from a text file.
9296 #+END_EXAMPLE
9297 @end example
9298
9299 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9300 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9301 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9302 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9303 whitespace before the colon:
9304
9305 @example
9306 Here is an example
9307 : Some example from a text file.
9308 @end example
9309
9310 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9311 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9312 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9313 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9314 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9315 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9316 achieved using either the listings or the
9317 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9318 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9319 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9320 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9321 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9322 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9323 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9324 blocks.
9325 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
9326
9327 @example
9328 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9329 (defun org-xor (a b)
9330 "Exclusive or."
9331 (if a (not b) b))
9332 #+END_SRC
9333 @end example
9334
9335 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9336 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9337 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9338 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9339 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9340 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9341 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9342 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9343 cool.
9344
9345 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9346 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9347 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9348 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9349 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9350 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9351 Here is an example:
9352
9353 @example
9354 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9355 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9356 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9357 #+END_SRC
9358 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9359 jumps to point-min.
9360 @end example
9361
9362 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9363 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9364 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9365 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9366
9367 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9368 areas in HTML export}).
9369
9370 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9371 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9372 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9373
9374 @table @kbd
9375 @kindex C-c '
9376 @item C-c '
9377 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9378 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9379 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9380 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9381 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9382 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9383 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9384 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9385 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9386 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9387 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9388 will create a new fixed-width region.
9389 @kindex C-c l
9390 @item C-c l
9391 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9392 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9393 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9394 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9395 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9396 @end table
9397
9398
9399 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9400 @section Include files
9401 @cindex include files, markup rules
9402
9403 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9404 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9405 @cindex #+INCLUDE
9406
9407 @example
9408 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9409 @end example
9410 @noindent
9411 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9412 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9413 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9414 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9415 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9416 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9417 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9418 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9419 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9420 use
9421
9422 @example
9423 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9424 @end example
9425
9426 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9427 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9428 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9429 obvious defaults.
9430
9431 @example
9432 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9433 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9434 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9435 @end example
9436
9437 @table @kbd
9438 @kindex C-c '
9439 @item C-c '
9440 Visit the include file at point.
9441 @end table
9442
9443 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9444 @section Index entries
9445 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9446
9447 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9448 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9449 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9450 an index} for more information.
9451
9452 @example
9453 * Curriculum Vitae
9454 #+INDEX: CV
9455 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9456 @end example
9457
9458
9459
9460
9461 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9462 @section Macro replacement
9463 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9464 @cindex #+MACRO
9465
9466 You can define text snippets with
9467
9468 @example
9469 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9470 @end example
9471
9472 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9473 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9474 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9475 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9476 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9477 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9478 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9479 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9480 @code{format-time-string}.
9481
9482 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9483 construct complex HTML code.
9484
9485
9486 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9487 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9488 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9489 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9490
9491 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9492 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9493 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9494 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9495 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9496 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9497 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9498 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9499 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9500
9501 @menu
9502 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9503 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9504 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9505 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9506 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9507 @end menu
9508
9509 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9510 @subsection Special symbols
9511 @cindex math symbols
9512 @cindex special symbols
9513 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9514 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9515 @cindex HTML entities
9516 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9517
9518 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9519 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9520 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9521 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9522 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9523 delimiters, for example:
9524
9525 @example
9526 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9527 @end example
9528
9529 @vindex org-entities
9530 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9531 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9532 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9533 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
9534 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9535 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9536
9537 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9538 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9539 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9540 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9541 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9542
9543 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9544 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9545 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9546 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9547
9548 @table @kbd
9549 @kindex C-c C-x \
9550 @item C-c C-x \
9551 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9552 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9553 for display purposes only.
9554 @end table
9555
9556 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9557 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9558 @cindex subscript
9559 @cindex superscript
9560
9561 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9562 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9563 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9564 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9565 with curly braces. For example
9566
9567 @example
9568 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9569 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9570 @end example
9571
9572 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9573 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9574 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9575 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9576 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9577 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9578 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9579
9580 @example
9581 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
9582 @end example
9583
9584 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9585 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9586
9587 @table @kbd
9588 @kindex C-c C-x \
9589 @item C-c C-x \
9590 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9591 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9592 @end table
9593
9594 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9595 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9596 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9597
9598 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9599 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9600 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9601 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9602 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9603 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9604 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9605 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9606 @file{MathJax} on your own
9607 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9608 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9609 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9610 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9611 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9612 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9613 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9614 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9615 DocBook documents.
9616
9617 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9618 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9619 @itemize @bullet
9620 @item
9621 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9622 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9623 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9624 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9625 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9626 @item
9627 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9628 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9629 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9630 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9631 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9632 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9633 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9634 @end itemize
9635
9636 @noindent For example:
9637
9638 @example
9639 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9640 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9641 \end@{equation@} % etc
9642
9643 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9644 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9645 @end example
9646
9647 @noindent
9648 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9649 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9650 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9651 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9652
9653 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9654 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9655 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9656 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9657 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9658 of these lines:
9659
9660 @example
9661 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9662 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9663 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9664 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9665 @end example
9666
9667 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9668 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9669 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9670
9671 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9672 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9673
9674 @table @kbd
9675 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
9676 @item C-c C-x C-l
9677 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9678 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9679 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9680 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9681 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9682 process the entire buffer.
9683 @kindex C-c C-c
9684 @item C-c C-c
9685 Remove the overlay preview images.
9686 @end table
9687
9688 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9689 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9690 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9691 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9692 preview images.
9693
9694 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9695 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9696 @cindex CD@LaTeX{}
9697
9698 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9699 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9700 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9701 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9702 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9703 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9704 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9705 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9706 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9707 Org files with
9708
9709 @lisp
9710 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9711 @end lisp
9712
9713 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9714 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9715 @itemize @bullet
9716 @kindex C-c @{
9717 @item
9718 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9719 @item
9720 @kindex @key{TAB}
9721 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9722 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9723 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9724 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9725 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9726 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9727 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9728 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9729 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9730 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9731 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9732 @item
9733 @kindex _
9734 @kindex ^
9735 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9736 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9737 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9738 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9739 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9740 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9741 @item
9742 @kindex `
9743 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9744 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9745 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9746 @item
9747 @kindex '
9748 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9749 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9750 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9751 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9752 is normal.
9753 @end itemize
9754
9755 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9756 @chapter Exporting
9757 @cindex exporting
9758
9759 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9760 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9761 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9762 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9763 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9764 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9765 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9766 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9767 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9768 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9769 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9770 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9771 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9772 these different formats.
9773
9774 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9775 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9776
9777 @menu
9778 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9779 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9780 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9781 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9782 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9783 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9784 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9785 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9786 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9787 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9788 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9789 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9790 @end menu
9791
9792 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9793 @section Selective export
9794 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9795
9796 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9797 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9798 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9799 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9800 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9801 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9802 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9803
9804 @enumerate
9805 @item
9806 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9807 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9808 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9809 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9810
9811 @item
9812 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9813 export.
9814
9815 @item
9816 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9817 be removed from the export buffer.
9818 @end enumerate
9819
9820 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9821 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9822 variable for more information.
9823
9824 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9825 @section Export options
9826 @cindex options, for export
9827
9828 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9829 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9830 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9831 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9832 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9833 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9834 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9835 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9836 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9837 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9838
9839 @table @kbd
9840 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9841 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9842 @end table
9843
9844 @cindex #+TITLE
9845 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9846 @cindex #+DATE
9847 @cindex #+EMAIL
9848 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9849 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9850 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9851 @cindex #+TEXT
9852 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9853 @cindex #+BIND
9854 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9855 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9856 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9857 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9858 @cindex #+XSLT
9859 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9860 @vindex user-full-name
9861 @vindex user-mail-address
9862 @vindex org-export-default-language
9863 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9864 @example
9865 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9866 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9867 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9868 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9869 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9870 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9871 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9872 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9873 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9874 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9875 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9876 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9877 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9878 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9879 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9880 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9881 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9882 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9883 @end example
9884
9885 @noindent
9886 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9887 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9888 settings. Here you can:
9889 @cindex headline levels
9890 @cindex section-numbers
9891 @cindex table of contents
9892 @cindex line-break preservation
9893 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9894 @cindex fixed-width sections
9895 @cindex tables
9896 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9897 @cindex footnotes
9898 @cindex special strings
9899 @cindex emphasized text
9900 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9901 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9902 @cindex author info, in export
9903 @cindex time info, in export
9904 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9905 @vindex org-export-author-info
9906 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9907 @vindex org-export-email-info
9908 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9909 @example
9910 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9911 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9912 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9913 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9914 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9915 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9916 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9917 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9918 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9919 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9920 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9921 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9922 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9923 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9924 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9925 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9926 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9927 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9928 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9929 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9930 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9931 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9932 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9933 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9934 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9935 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9936 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9937 @end example
9938 @noindent
9939 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9940 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9941 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9942
9943 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9944 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9945 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9946 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9947
9948 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9949 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9950 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9951 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9952 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9953
9954 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9955 @section The export dispatcher
9956 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9957
9958 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9959 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9960 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9961 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9962 the subtrees are exported.
9963
9964 @table @kbd
9965 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9966 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9967 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9968 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9969 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9970 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9971 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9972 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9973 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9974 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9975 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
9976 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9977 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9978 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9979 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
9980 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9981 @end table
9982
9983 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9984 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9985 @cindex ASCII export
9986 @cindex Latin-1 export
9987 @cindex UTF-8 export
9988
9989 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9990 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9991 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9992
9993 @cindex region, active
9994 @cindex active region
9995 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9996 @table @kbd
9997 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9998 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9999 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
10000 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
10001 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10002 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10003 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10004 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
10005 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
10006 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10007 export.
10008 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10009 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10010 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10011 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10012 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10013 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10014 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10015 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10016 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10017 Export only the visible part of the document.
10018 @end table
10019
10020 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10021 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10022 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10023 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10024 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10025
10026 @example
10027 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10028 @end example
10029
10030 @noindent
10031 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10032 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10033 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10034 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10035 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10036 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10037 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10038
10039 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10040 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10041 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10042 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10043
10044 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10045 @section HTML export
10046 @cindex HTML export
10047
10048 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10049 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10050 language, but with additional support for tables.
10051
10052 @menu
10053 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10054 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10055 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10056 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10057 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10058 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10059 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10060 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10061 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10062 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10063 @end menu
10064
10065 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10066 @subsection HTML export commands
10067
10068 @cindex region, active
10069 @cindex active region
10070 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10071 @table @kbd
10072 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10073 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10074 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10075 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10076 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10077 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10078 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10079 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10080 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10081 property, that name will be used for the export.
10082 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10083 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10084 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10085 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10086 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10087 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10088 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10089 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10090 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10091 Export only the visible part of the document.
10092 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10093 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10094 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10095 buffer.
10096 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10097 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10098 code.
10099 @end table
10100
10101 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10102 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10103 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10104 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10105 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10106
10107 @example
10108 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10109 @end example
10110
10111 @noindent
10112 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10113
10114
10115 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10116 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10117 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10118 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10119 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10120 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10121 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10122 @vindex org-export-author-info
10123 @vindex org-export-email-info
10124 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10125 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10126
10127 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10128
10129 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10130 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10131 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10132
10133 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10134 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10135 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10136 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10137 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10138 insert any preamble.
10139
10140 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10141 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10142 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10143 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10144 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10145 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10146 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10147 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10148 insert any postamble.
10149
10150 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10151 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10152
10153 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
10154 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10155 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10156 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10157 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10158 the exported file use either
10159
10160 @cindex #+HTML
10161 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10162 @example
10163 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10164 @end example
10165
10166 @noindent or
10167 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10168
10169 @example
10170 #+BEGIN_HTML
10171 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10172 #+END_HTML
10173 @end example
10174
10175
10176 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10177 @subsection Links in HTML export
10178
10179 @cindex links, in HTML export
10180 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10181 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10182 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10183 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10184 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10185 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10186 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10187 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10188 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10189 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10190 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10191
10192 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10193 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10194 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10195 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10196
10197 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10198 @example
10199 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10200 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10201 @end example
10202
10203 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10204 @subsection Tables
10205 @cindex tables, in HTML
10206 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10207
10208 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10209 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10210 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10211 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10212
10213 @cindex #+CAPTION
10214 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10215 @example
10216 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10217 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10218 @end example
10219
10220 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10221 @subsection Images in HTML export
10222
10223 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10224 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10225 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10226 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10227 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10228 default@footnote{But see the variable
10229 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10230 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10231 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10232 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10233 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10234 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10235 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10236 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10237
10238 @example
10239 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10240 @end example
10241
10242 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10243 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10244 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10245
10246 @cindex #+CAPTION
10247 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10248 @example
10249 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10250 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10251 [[./img/a.jpg]]
10252 @end example
10253
10254 @noindent
10255 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10256
10257 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10258 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10259 @cindex MathJax
10260 @cindex dvipng
10261
10262 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10263 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10264 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10265 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10266 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10267 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10268 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10269 found on the MathJax website, see
10270 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10271 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10272 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10273 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10274
10275 @example
10276 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10277 @end example
10278
10279 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10280 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10281 this line.
10282
10283 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10284 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10285 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10286 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10287 You can still get this processing with
10288
10289 @example
10290 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10291 @end example
10292
10293 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10294 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10295
10296 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10297 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10298 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10299 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10300 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10301 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10302 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10303 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10304 respectively. For example
10305
10306 @example
10307 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10308 (defun org-xor (a b)
10309 "Exclusive or."
10310 (if a (not b) b))
10311 #+END_EXAMPLE
10312 @end example
10313
10314
10315 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10316 @subsection CSS support
10317 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10318 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10319
10320 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10321 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10322 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10323 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10324 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10325 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10326 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10327 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10328 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10329 @example
10330 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10331 p.date @r{publishing date}
10332 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10333 .title @r{document title}
10334 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10335 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10336 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10337 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10338 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10339 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10340 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10341 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10342 .target @r{target for links}
10343 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10344 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10345 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10346 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10347 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10348 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10349 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10350 pre.example @r{normal example}
10351 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10352 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10353 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10354 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10355 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10356 @end example
10357
10358 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10359 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10360 @vindex org-export-html-style
10361 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10362 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10363 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10364 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10365 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10366 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10367 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10368 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10369 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10370 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10371 individually for each file, you can use
10372
10373 @cindex #+STYLE
10374 @example
10375 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10376 @end example
10377
10378 @noindent
10379 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10380 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10381 referring to an external file.
10382
10383 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10384 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10385 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10386 property.
10387
10388 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10389 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10390
10391 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10392 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10393
10394 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10395 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10396 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10397 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10398 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10399 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10400 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10401 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10402 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10403 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10404 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10405 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10406 copy on your own web server.
10407
10408 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10409 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10410 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10411 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10412 adding a single line to the Org file:
10413
10414 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10415 @example
10416 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10417 @end example
10418
10419 @noindent
10420 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10421 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10422 viewing options:
10423
10424 @example
10425 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10426 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10427 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10428 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10429 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10430 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10431 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10432 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10433 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10434 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10435 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10436 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10437 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10438 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10439 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10440 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10441 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10442 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10443 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10444 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10445 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10446 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10447 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10448 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10449 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10450 @end example
10451 @noindent
10452 @vindex org-infojs-options
10453 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10454 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10455 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10456 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10457
10458 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10459 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10460 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10461 @cindex PDF export
10462 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10463
10464 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10465 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10466 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10467 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10468 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10469 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10470 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10471 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10472 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10473 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10474 sections.
10475
10476 @menu
10477 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10478 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10479 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10480 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10481 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10482 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10483 @end menu
10484
10485 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10486 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10487
10488 @cindex region, active
10489 @cindex active region
10490 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10491 @table @kbd
10492 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10493 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10494 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10495 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10496 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10497 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10498 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10499 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10500 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10501 property, that name will be used for the export.
10502 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10503 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10504 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10505 Export only the visible part of the document.
10506 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10507 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10508 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10509 buffer.
10510 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10511 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10512 code.
10513 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10514 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10515 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10516 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10517 @end table
10518
10519 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10520 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10521 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10522 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10523 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10524 convert them to a custom string depending on
10525 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10526
10527 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10528 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10529
10530 @example
10531 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10532 @end example
10533
10534 @noindent
10535 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10536
10537 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10538 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10539 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10540 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10541 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10542 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10543 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10544
10545 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10546
10547 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10548 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10549 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10550 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10551 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10552 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10553 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10554 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10555 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10556 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10557 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10558 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10559 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10560 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10561 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10562 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10563 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10564 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10565 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10566 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10567 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10568 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10569 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10570 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10571 below.
10572
10573 @example
10574 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10575 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10576 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10577
10578 * Headline 1
10579 some text
10580 @end example
10581
10582 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10583 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10584
10585 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10586 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10587 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10588 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10589 the following constructs:
10590
10591 @cindex #+LaTeX
10592 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10593 @example
10594 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10595 @end example
10596
10597 @noindent or
10598 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10599
10600 @example
10601 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10602 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10603 #+END_LaTeX
10604 @end example
10605
10606
10607 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10608 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10609 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10610
10611 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10612 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10613 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10614 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10615 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10616 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10617 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10618 width:
10619
10620 @cindex #+CAPTION
10621 @cindex #+LABEL
10622 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10623 @example
10624 #+CAPTION: A long table
10625 #+LABEL: tbl:long
10626 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10627 | ..... | ..... |
10628 | ..... | ..... |
10629 @end example
10630
10631 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10632
10633 @cindex #+CAPTION
10634 @cindex #+LABEL
10635 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10636 @example
10637 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10638 #+LABEL: tbl:wide
10639 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10640 | ..... | ..... |
10641 | ..... | ..... |
10642 @end example
10643
10644 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10645 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10646 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10647 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10648
10649 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10650 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10651 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10652 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10653 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10654 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10655 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10656 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10657 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10658 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10659 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10660 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10661 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10662 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10663 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10664 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10665
10666 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10667 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10668 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10669 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10670 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10671 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10672
10673 @cindex #+CAPTION
10674 @cindex #+LABEL
10675 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10676 @example
10677 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10678 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10679 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10680 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10681
10682 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10683 [[./img/hst.png]]
10684 @end example
10685
10686 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10687 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10688 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10689
10690 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10691 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10692
10693 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10694 @subsection Beamer class export
10695
10696 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10697 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10698 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10699
10700 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10701 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10702 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10703 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10704 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10705 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10706 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10707 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10708 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10709 structure of the presentation.
10710
10711 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10712 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10713 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10714 editing special properties used by beamer.
10715
10716 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10717 properties:
10718
10719 @table @code
10720 @item BEAMER_env
10721 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10722 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10723 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10724 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10725 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10726 @item BEAMER_envargs
10727 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10728 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10729 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10730 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10731 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10732 environment.
10733 @item BEAMER_col
10734 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10735 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10736 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10737 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10738 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10739 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10740 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10741 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10742 @item BEAMER_extra
10743 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10744 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10745 transitions.
10746 @end table
10747
10748 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10749 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10750 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10751 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10752 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10753 in the presentation as well.
10754
10755 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10756 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10757 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10758 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10759 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10760 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10761 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10762
10763 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10764 support with
10765
10766 @example
10767 #+STARTUP: beamer
10768 @end example
10769
10770 @table @kbd
10771 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10772 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10773 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10774 @end table
10775
10776 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10777 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10778 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10779 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10780
10781 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10782
10783 @smallexample
10784 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10785 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10786 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10787 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10788 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10789 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10790 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10791
10792 * This is the first structural section
10793
10794 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10795 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10796 :PROPERTIES:
10797 :BEAMER_env: block
10798 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10799 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10800 :END:
10801 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10802 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10803 :PROPERTIES:
10804 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10805 :BEAMER_env: block
10806 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10807 :END:
10808 for contributing to the discussion
10809 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10810 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10811 *** Request :B_block:
10812 Please test this stuff!
10813 :PROPERTIES:
10814 :BEAMER_env: block
10815 :END:
10816 @end smallexample
10817
10818 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10819
10820 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10821 @section DocBook export
10822 @cindex DocBook export
10823 @cindex PDF export
10824 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10825
10826 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10827 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10828 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10829 tools and stylesheets.
10830
10831 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10832
10833 @menu
10834 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10835 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10836 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10837 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10838 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10839 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10840 @end menu
10841
10842 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10843 @subsection DocBook export commands
10844
10845 @cindex region, active
10846 @cindex active region
10847 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10848 @table @kbd
10849 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10850 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10851 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10852 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10853 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10854 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10855 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10856 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10857 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10858 property, that name will be used for the export.
10859 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10860 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10861
10862 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10863 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10864 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10865 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10866 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10867 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10868
10869 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10870 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10871 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10872 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10873 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10874 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10875
10876 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10877 Export only the visible part of the document.
10878 @end table
10879
10880 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10881 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10882
10883 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10884 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10885
10886 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10887 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10888 @example
10889 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10890 @end example
10891
10892 @noindent or
10893 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10894
10895 @example
10896 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10897 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10898 literally.
10899 #+END_DOCBOOK
10900 @end example
10901
10902 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10903 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10904 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10905 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10906
10907 @example
10908 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10909 <warning>
10910 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10911 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10912 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10913 </warning>
10914 #+END_DOCBOOK
10915 @end example
10916
10917 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10918 @subsection Recursive sections
10919 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10920
10921 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10922 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
10923 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10924 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10925 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10926 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10927
10928 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10929 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10930
10931 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10932 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10933 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10934
10935 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10936 DocBook V4.3.
10937
10938 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10939 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10940 using the @code{table} element.
10941
10942 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10943 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10944 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10945 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10946
10947 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10948 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10949 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10950 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10951 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10952 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10953 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10954 @code{mediaobject} element.
10955
10956 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10957 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10958 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10959 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10960 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10961 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10962 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10963 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10964
10965 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10966 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10967 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10968 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10969 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10970 set:
10971
10972 @cindex #+CAPTION
10973 @cindex #+LABEL
10974 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10975 @example
10976 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10977 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10978 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10979 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10980 @end example
10981
10982 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10983 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10984 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10985 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10986 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10987
10988 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10989 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10990 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10991
10992 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10993 @vindex org-entities
10994 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10995 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10996 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10997 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10998 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10999 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
11000
11001 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
11002 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
11003 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
11004 special characters included in XHTML entities:
11005
11006 @example
11007 "<!DOCTYPE article [
11008 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11009 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11010 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11011 >
11012 %xhtml1-symbol;
11013 ]>
11014 "
11015 @end example
11016
11017 @c begin opendocument
11018
11019 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11020 @section OpenDocument Text export
11021 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11022 @cindex ODT
11023 @cindex OpenDocument
11024 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11025 @cindex LibreOffice
11026 @cindex org-odt.el
11027 @cindex org-modules
11028
11029 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11030 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11031 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11032 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11033 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11034 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11035
11036 @menu
11037 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11038 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11039 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11040 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11041 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11042 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11043 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11044 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11045 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11046 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11047 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11048 @end menu
11049
11050 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11051 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11052 @cindex zip
11053 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11054 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11055
11056 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11057 @subsection ODT export commands
11058
11059 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11060 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11061
11062 @cindex region, active
11063 @cindex active region
11064 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11065 @table @kbd
11066 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11067 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11068
11069 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11070
11071 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11072 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11073 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11074 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11075
11076 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11077 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11078 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11079 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11080 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11081 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11082 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11083 export.
11084
11085 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11086 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11087
11088 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11089 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11090 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11091 exporting to other formats}.
11092 @end table
11093
11094 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11095 @subsection Extending ODT export
11096
11097 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11098 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11099 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11100 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11101
11102 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11103 @cindex LibreOffice
11104 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11105 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11106 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11107 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11108 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11109 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11110 document converter}.
11111
11112 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11113 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11114
11115 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11116 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11117 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11118 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11119 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11120 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11121 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11122 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11123
11124 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11125 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11126
11127 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11128 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11129 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11130 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11131 the following command.
11132
11133 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11134 @table @kbd
11135
11136 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11137 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11138 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11139 @end table
11140
11141 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11142 @subsection Applying custom styles
11143 @cindex styles, custom
11144 @cindex template, custom
11145
11146 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11147 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11148 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11149 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11150 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11151 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11152 users alike, and is described here.
11153
11154 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
11155
11156 @enumerate
11157 @item
11158 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11159 to ODT format.
11160
11161 @example
11162 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11163 @end example
11164
11165 @item
11166 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11167 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
11168 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11169 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11170
11171 @item
11172 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11173 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11174 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11175 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11176 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11177
11178 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11179 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11180
11181 @example
11182 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11183 @end example
11184
11185 or
11186
11187 @example
11188 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11189 @end example
11190
11191 @end enumerate
11192
11193 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11194
11195 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11196 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11197 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11198 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11199 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11200 the factory settings.
11201
11202 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11203 @subsection Links in ODT export
11204 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11205
11206 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11207 Internet-style links for all other links.
11208
11209 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11210 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11211
11212 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11213 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11214 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11215
11216 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11217 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11218 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11219
11220 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11221 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
11222 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
11223 stripped from the exported document.
11224
11225 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11226 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11227 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11228 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11229 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11230 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11231
11232 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11233 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11234 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11235
11236 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11237 mentioned above.
11238
11239 @example
11240 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11241 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11242 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11243 | / | < | | | < |
11244 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11245 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11246 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11247 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11248 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11249 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11250 @end example
11251
11252 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11253 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11254 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11255 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11256 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11257
11258 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11259 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11260 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11261
11262 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11263 @subsection Images in ODT export
11264 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11265 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11266
11267 @subsubheading Embedding images
11268 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11269 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11270 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11271
11272 @example
11273 [[file:img.png]]
11274 @end example
11275
11276 @example
11277 [[./img.png]]
11278 @end example
11279
11280 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11281 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11282 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11283 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11284 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11285
11286 @example
11287 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11288 @end example
11289
11290 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11291
11292 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11293 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11294 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11295
11296 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11297 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11298 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11299 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11300 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11301 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11302 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11303 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11304 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11305 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11306 converted in to units of centimeters using
11307 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11308 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11309 achieve the best results.
11310
11311 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11312
11313 @table @asis
11314 @item Explicitly size the image
11315 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11316
11317 @example
11318 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11319 [[./img.png]]
11320 @end example
11321
11322 @item Scale the image
11323 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11324
11325 @example
11326 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11327 [[./img.png]]
11328 @end example
11329
11330 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11331 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11332 height:width ratio, do the following:
11333
11334 @example
11335 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11336 [[./img.png]]
11337 @end example
11338
11339 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11340 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11341 height:width ratio, do the following
11342
11343 @example
11344 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11345 [[./img.png]]
11346 @end example
11347 @end table
11348
11349 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11350
11351 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11352 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11353 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11354 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11355 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11356
11357 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11358 @example
11359 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11360 [[./img.png]]
11361 @end example
11362
11363 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11364 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11365
11366 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11367
11368 @menu
11369 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11370 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11371 @end menu
11372
11373 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11374 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11375
11376 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11377 document in one of the following ways:
11378
11379 @cindex MathML
11380 @enumerate
11381 @item MathML
11382
11383 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11384
11385 @example
11386 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t
11387 @end example
11388
11389 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11390 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11391 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11392 the exported document.
11393
11394 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11395 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11396
11397 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11398 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11399 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11400
11401 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11402 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11403 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11404
11405 @lisp
11406 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11407 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11408 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11409 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11410 @end lisp
11411
11412 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11413 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11414
11415 @table @kbd
11416
11417 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11418 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11419
11420 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11421 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11422 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11423 @end table
11424
11425 @cindex dvipng
11426 @item PNG images
11427
11428 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11429
11430 @example
11431 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11432 @end example
11433
11434 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11435 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11436 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11437 @end enumerate
11438
11439 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11440 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11441
11442 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11443 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11444 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11445 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11446
11447 @example
11448 [[./equation.mml]]
11449 @end example
11450
11451 or
11452
11453 @example
11454 [[./equation.odf]]
11455 @end example
11456
11457 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11458 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11459
11460 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11461 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11462 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11463 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11464 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11465 appearance in the Org file.
11466
11467 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11468 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11469 file.
11470
11471 @example
11472 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11473 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11474 [[./img/a.png]]
11475 @end example
11476
11477 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11478
11479 @example
11480 Figure 2: Bell curve
11481 @end example
11482
11483 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11484 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11485 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11486 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11487 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11488
11489 @lisp
11490 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11491 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11492 @end lisp
11493
11494 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11495 document.
11496
11497 @example
11498 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11499 @end example
11500
11501 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11502 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11503
11504 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11505 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11506 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11507 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11508 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11509 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11510 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11511
11512 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11513 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11514 by customizing the variable
11515 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11516
11517 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11518 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11519 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11520
11521 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11522 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11523
11524 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11525 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11526 that would be of interest to power users.
11527
11528 @menu
11529 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11530 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11531 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11532 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11533 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11534 @end menu
11535
11536 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11537 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11538 @cindex convert
11539 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11540 @cindex converter
11541
11542 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11543 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11544 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11545 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11546
11547 @enumerate
11548 @item Register the converter
11549
11550 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11551 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11552 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11553 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11554
11555 @item Configure its capabilities
11556
11557 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11558 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11559 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11560 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11561 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11562 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11563 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11564 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11565
11566 @item Choose the converter
11567
11568 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11569 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11570 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11571 @end enumerate
11572
11573 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11574 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11575 @cindex styles, custom
11576 @cindex template, custom
11577
11578 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11579 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11580 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11581 the exporter.
11582
11583 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11584 @subsubheading Factory styles
11585
11586 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11587 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11588 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11589
11590 @itemize
11591 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11592 @item
11593 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11594
11595 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11596 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11597 @enumerate
11598
11599 @item
11600 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11601
11602 @item
11603 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11604 blocks.
11605 @end enumerate
11606
11607 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11608 @item
11609 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11610
11611 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11612 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11613 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11614
11615 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11616 file serves the following purposes:
11617 @enumerate
11618
11619 @item
11620 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11621 the exporter.
11622
11623 @item
11624 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11625 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11626 are numbered.
11627 @end enumerate
11628 @end itemize
11629
11630 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11631 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11632 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11633 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11634 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11635 exporter.
11636
11637 @itemize
11638 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11639 @item
11640 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11641
11642 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11643 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11644
11645 @enumerate
11646 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11647
11648 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11649
11650 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11651
11652 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11653 Template file
11654
11655 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11656
11657 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11658 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11659 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11660
11661 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11662 like header and footer images.
11663
11664 @item @code{nil}
11665
11666 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11667 @end enumerate
11668
11669 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11670 @item
11671 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11672
11673 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11674 in the final output.
11675 @end itemize
11676
11677 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11678 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11679
11680 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11681 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11682 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11683
11684 @enumerate
11685 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11686
11687 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11688 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11689
11690 @example
11691 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11692 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11693 regular text.
11694 @end example
11695
11696 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11697 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11698 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11699
11700 @example
11701 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11702 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11703 </style:style>
11704 @end example
11705
11706 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11707
11708 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11709 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11710
11711 @example
11712 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11713 @end example
11714
11715 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11716 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11717 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11718
11719 @example
11720 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11721 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11722 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11723 </style:style>
11724 @end example
11725
11726 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11727
11728 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11729 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11730
11731 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11732 following:
11733
11734 @example
11735 #+BEGIN_ODT
11736 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11737 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11738 </text:p>
11739 #+END_ODT
11740 @end example
11741
11742 @end enumerate
11743
11744 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11745 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11746 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11747
11748 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11749 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11750 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11751 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11752
11753 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11754 OpenDocument-v1.2
11755 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11756 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11757
11758
11759
11760 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11761
11762 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11763 the table that follows.
11764
11765 @lisp
11766 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11767 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11768 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11769 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11770 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11771 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11772 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11773 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11774 @end lisp
11775
11776 @example
11777 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11778 | Name | Phone | Age |
11779 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11780 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11781 @end example
11782
11783 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11784 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11785 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11786 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11787 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11788 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11789 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11790 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11791
11792 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11793 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11794
11795 @enumerate
11796 @item
11797 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11798 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11799
11800 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11801 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11802
11803 @itemize @minus
11804 @item Body
11805 @item First column
11806 @item Last column
11807 @item First row
11808 @item Last row
11809 @item Even row
11810 @item Odd row
11811 @item Even column
11812 @item Odd Column
11813 @end itemize
11814
11815 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11816 template using a well-defined convention.
11817
11818 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11819 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11820 the following table.
11821
11822 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11823 @headitem Table cell type
11824 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11825 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11826 @item
11827 @tab
11828 @tab
11829 @item Body
11830 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11831 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11832 @item First column
11833 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11834 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11835 @item Last column
11836 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11837 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11838 @item First row
11839 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11840 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11841 @item Last row
11842 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11843 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11844 @item Even row
11845 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11846 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11847 @item Odd row
11848 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11849 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11850 @item Even column
11851 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11852 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11853 @item Odd column
11854 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11855 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11856 @end multitable
11857
11858 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11859 styles in the
11860 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11861 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11862 styles}).
11863
11864 @item
11865 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11866 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11867 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11868 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11869 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11870 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11871
11872 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11873 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11874 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11875
11876 @itemize @minus
11877 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11878 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11879 @end itemize
11880
11881 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11882 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11883 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11884 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11885
11886 @lisp
11887 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11888 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11889 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11890 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11891 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11892 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11893 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11894 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11895 @end lisp
11896
11897 @item
11898 Associate a table with the table style
11899
11900 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11901 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11902
11903 @example
11904 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11905 | Name | Phone | Age |
11906 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11907 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11908 @end example
11909 @end enumerate
11910
11911 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11912 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11913
11914 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11915 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11916 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11917 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11918 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11919
11920 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11921 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11922 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11923 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11924
11925 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11926 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11927 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11928 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11929 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11930 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11931
11932 @c end opendocument
11933
11934 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11935 @section TaskJuggler export
11936 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11937 @cindex Project management
11938
11939 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11940 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11941 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11942 you have provided.
11943
11944 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11945 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11946 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11947 document.
11948
11949 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11950 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11951 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11952 all the nodes.
11953
11954 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11955
11956 @table @kbd
11957 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11958 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11959
11960 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11961 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11962 @end table
11963
11964 @subsection Tasks
11965
11966 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11967 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11968 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11969 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11970 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11971 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11972 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11973 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11974 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11975 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11976
11977 @subsection Resources
11978
11979 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11980 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11981 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11982 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11983 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11984 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11985 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11986 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11987 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11988 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11989 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11990 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11991 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11992
11993 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11994 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11995 time.
11996
11997 @subsection Export of properties
11998
11999 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if a
12000 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
12001 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
12002 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
12003 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
12004 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
12005 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
12006 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
12007 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
12008
12009 @subsection Dependencies
12010
12011 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12012 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12013 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12014 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12015 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12016 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12017 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12018 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12019 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12020 examples should illustrate this:
12021
12022 @example
12023 * Preparation
12024 :PROPERTIES:
12025 :task_id: preparation
12026 :ORDERED: t
12027 :END:
12028 * Training material
12029 :PROPERTIES:
12030 :task_id: training_material
12031 :ORDERED: t
12032 :END:
12033 ** Markup Guidelines
12034 :PROPERTIES:
12035 :Effort: 2d
12036 :END:
12037 ** Workflow Guidelines
12038 :PROPERTIES:
12039 :Effort: 2d
12040 :END:
12041 * Presentation
12042 :PROPERTIES:
12043 :Effort: 2d
12044 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12045 :END:
12046 @end example
12047
12048 @subsection Reports
12049
12050 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12051 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12052 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12053 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12054 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12055 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12056 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12057 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12058
12059 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12060 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12061
12062 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12063 @section Freemind export
12064 @cindex Freemind export
12065 @cindex mind map
12066
12067 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12068
12069 @table @kbd
12070 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12071 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12072 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12073 @end table
12074
12075 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12076 @section XOXO export
12077 @cindex XOXO export
12078
12079 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12080 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12081 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12082
12083 @table @kbd
12084 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12085 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12086 @file{myfile.html}.
12087 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12088 Export only the visible part of the document.
12089 @end table
12090
12091 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12092 @section iCalendar export
12093 @cindex iCalendar export
12094
12095 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12096 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12097 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12098 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12099 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12100 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12101 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12102 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12103 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12104 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12105 included in the export, configure the variable
12106 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12107 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12108 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12109 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12110 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12111 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12112 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12113 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12114 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12115 time.
12116
12117 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12118 @cindex property, ID
12119 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12120 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12121 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12122 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12123 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12124 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12125 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12126 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12127 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12128
12129 @table @kbd
12130 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12131 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12132 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12133 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12134 @vindex org-agenda-files
12135 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12136 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12137 file will be written.
12138 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12139 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12140 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12141 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12142 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12143 @end table
12144
12145 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12146 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12147 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12148 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12149 @cindex property, LOCATION
12150 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12151 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12152 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12153 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12154 and the description from the body (limited to
12155 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12156
12157 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12158 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12159
12160 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12161 @chapter Publishing
12162 @cindex publishing
12163
12164 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12165 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12166 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12167 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12168 server.
12169
12170 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12171 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12172
12173 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12174
12175 @menu
12176 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12177 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12178 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12179 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12180 @end menu
12181
12182 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12183 @section Configuration
12184
12185 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12186 and many other properties of a project.
12187
12188 @menu
12189 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12190 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12191 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12192 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12193 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12194 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12195 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12196 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12197 @end menu
12198
12199 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12200 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12201 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12202 @cindex projects, for publishing
12203
12204 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12205 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12206 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12207 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12208
12209 @lisp
12210 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12211 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12212 @r{or}
12213 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12214
12215 @end lisp
12216
12217 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12218 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12219 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12220 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12221 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12222 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12223 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12224 sequence given.
12225
12226 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12227 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12228 @cindex directories, for publishing
12229
12230 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12231 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12232 and where to put published files.
12233
12234 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12235 @item @code{:base-directory}
12236 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12237 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12238 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12239 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12240 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12241 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12242 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12243 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12244 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12245 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12246 variable @code{project-plist}.
12247 @item @code{:completion-function}
12248 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12249 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12250 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12251 @code{project-plist}.
12252 @end multitable
12253 @noindent
12254
12255 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12256 @subsection Selecting files
12257 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12258
12259 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12260 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12261 properties
12262 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12263 @item @code{:base-extension}
12264 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12265 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12266 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12267
12268 @item @code{:exclude}
12269 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12270 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12271 extension.
12272
12273 @item @code{:include}
12274 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12275 and @code{:exclude}.
12276
12277 @item @code{:recursive}
12278 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12279 @end multitable
12280
12281 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12282 @subsection Publishing action
12283 @cindex action, for publishing
12284
12285 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12286 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12287 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12288 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12289 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12290 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12291 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12292 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12293 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12294 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12295 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12296 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12297 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12298 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12299 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12300 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12301 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12302 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12303 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12304
12305 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12306 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12307 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12308 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12309 @item @code{:plain-source}
12310 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12311 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12312 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12313 @end multitable
12314
12315 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12316 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12317 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12318 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12319 and place the result into the destination folder.
12320
12321 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12322 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12323 @cindex options, for publishing
12324
12325 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12326 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12327 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12328 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12329 respective variable for details.
12330
12331 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12332 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12333 @vindex org-export-default-language
12334 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12335 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12336 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12337 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12338 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12339 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12340 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12341 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12342 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12343 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12344 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12345 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12346 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12347 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12348 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12349 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12350 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12351 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12352 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12353 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12354 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12355 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12356 @vindex org-export-author-info
12357 @vindex org-export-email-info
12358 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12359 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12360 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12361 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12362 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12363 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12364 @vindex org-export-html-style
12365 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12366 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12367 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12368 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12369 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12370 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12371 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12372 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12373 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12374 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12375 @vindex user-full-name
12376 @vindex user-mail-address
12377 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12378 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12379
12380 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12381 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12382 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12383 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12384 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12385 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12386 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12387 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12388 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12389 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12390 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12391 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12392 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12393 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12394 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12395 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12396 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12397 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12398 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12399 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12400 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12401 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12402 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12403 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12404 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12405 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12406 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12407 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12408 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12409 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12410 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12411 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12412 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12413 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12414 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12415 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12416 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12417 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12418 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12419 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12420 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12421 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12422 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12423 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12424 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12425 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12426 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12427 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12428 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12429 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12430 @end multitable
12431
12432 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12433 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12434 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12435 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12436 options.
12437
12438
12439
12440 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12441 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12442 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12443 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12444 options}), however, override everything.
12445
12446 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12447 @subsection Links between published files
12448 @cindex links, publishing
12449
12450 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12451 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12452 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12453 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12454 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12455 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12456 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12457 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12458 @file{html} file.
12459
12460 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12461 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12462 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12463 an example of this usage.
12464
12465 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12466 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12467 location. In this case, use the property
12468
12469 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12470 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12471 @tab Function to validate links
12472 @end multitable
12473
12474 @noindent
12475 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12476 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12477 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12478 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12479 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12480 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12481 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12482
12483 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12484 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12485 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12486
12487 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12488 a map of files for a given project.
12489
12490 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12491 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12492 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12493 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12494
12495 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12496 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12497 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12498
12499 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12500 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12501
12502 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12503 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12504 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12505 of links to all files in the project.
12506
12507 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12508 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12509 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12510 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12511
12512 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12513 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12514 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12515 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12516 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12517 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12518 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12519
12520 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12521 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12522
12523 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12524 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12525 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12526 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12527 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12528 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12529 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12530
12531 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12532 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12533 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12534 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12535
12536 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12537 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12538 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12539 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12540
12541 @end multitable
12542
12543 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12544 @subsection Generating an index
12545 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12546
12547 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12548
12549 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12550 @item @code{:makeindex}
12551 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12552 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12553 @end multitable
12554
12555 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12556 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12557 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12558 a title, style information, etc.
12559
12560 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12561 @section Uploading files
12562 @cindex rsync
12563 @cindex unison
12564
12565 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12566 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12567 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12568 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12569 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12570 under heavy usage.
12571
12572 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12573 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12574 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12575 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12576 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12577
12578 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12579 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12580 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12581 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12582 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12583 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12584 tool syncs them.
12585
12586 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12587 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12588 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12589 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12590 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12591 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12592
12593 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12594 @section Sample configuration
12595
12596 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12597 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12598 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12599
12600 @menu
12601 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12602 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12603 @end menu
12604
12605 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12606 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12607
12608 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12609 directory on the local machine.
12610
12611 @lisp
12612 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12613 '(("org"
12614 :base-directory "~/org/"
12615 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12616 :section-numbers nil
12617 :table-of-contents nil
12618 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12619 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12620 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12621 @end lisp
12622
12623 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12624 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12625
12626 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12627 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12628 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12629 excluded.
12630
12631 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12632 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12633 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12634 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12635 @c
12636 @example
12637 file:../images/myimage.png
12638 @end example
12639 @c
12640 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12641 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12642 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12643
12644 @lisp
12645 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12646 '(("orgfiles"
12647 :base-directory "~/org/"
12648 :base-extension "org"
12649 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12650 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12651 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12652 :headline-levels 3
12653 :section-numbers nil
12654 :table-of-contents nil
12655 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12656 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12657 :html-preamble t)
12658
12659 ("images"
12660 :base-directory "~/images/"
12661 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12662 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12663 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12664
12665 ("other"
12666 :base-directory "~/other/"
12667 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12668 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12669 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12670 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12671 @end lisp
12672
12673 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12674 @section Triggering publication
12675
12676 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12677
12678 @table @kbd
12679 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12680 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12681 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12682 Publish the project containing the current file.
12683 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12684 Publish only the current file.
12685 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12686 Publish every project.
12687 @end table
12688
12689 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12690 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12691 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12692 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12693 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12694 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12695 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12696
12697 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12698 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12699
12700 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12701 @chapter Working with source code
12702 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12703 @cindex Davison, Dan
12704 @cindex source code, working with
12705
12706 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12707 e.g.:
12708
12709 @example
12710 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12711 (defun org-xor (a b)
12712 "Exclusive or."
12713 (if a (not b) b))
12714 #+END_SRC
12715 @end example
12716
12717 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12718 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12719 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12720 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12721 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12722 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12723
12724 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12725
12726 @menu
12727 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12728 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12729 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12730 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12731 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12732 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12733 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12734 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12735 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12736 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12737 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12738 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12739 @end menu
12740
12741 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12742 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12743
12744 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12745 @section Structure of code blocks
12746 @cindex code block, structure
12747 @cindex source code, block structure
12748 @cindex #+NAME
12749 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12750
12751 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12752 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12753 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12754
12755 @example
12756 #+NAME: <name>
12757 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12758 <body>
12759 #+END_SRC
12760 @end example
12761
12762 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12763 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12764 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12765 @cindex source code, inline
12766
12767 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12768
12769 @example
12770 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12771 @end example
12772
12773 or
12774
12775 @example
12776 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12777 @end example
12778
12779 @table @code
12780 @item <#+NAME: name>
12781 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12782 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12783 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12784 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12785 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12786 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12787 undefined.
12788 @cindex #+NAME
12789 @item <language>
12790 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12791 @cindex source code, language
12792 @item <switches>
12793 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12794 @ref{Literal examples})
12795 @cindex source code, switches
12796 @item <header arguments>
12797 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12798 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12799 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12800 basis using properties.
12801 @item source code, header arguments
12802 @item <body>
12803 Source code in the specified language.
12804 @end table
12805
12806 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12807 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12808
12809 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12810 @section Editing source code
12811 @cindex code block, editing
12812 @cindex source code, editing
12813
12814 @kindex C-c '
12815 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12816 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12817 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12818 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12819
12820 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12821 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12822 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12823 further configuration options.
12824
12825 @table @code
12826 @item org-src-lang-modes
12827 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12828 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12829 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12830 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12831 @item org-src-window-setup
12832 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12833 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12834 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12835 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12836 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12837 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12838 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12839 @end table
12840
12841 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12842 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12843
12844 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12845 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12846
12847 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12848 @section Exporting code blocks
12849 @cindex code block, exporting
12850 @cindex source code, exporting
12851
12852 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12853 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12854 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12855 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12856 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12857 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12858
12859 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12860 behavior:
12861
12862 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12863 @table @code
12864 @item :exports code
12865 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12866 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12867 @item :exports results
12868 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12869 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12870 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12871 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12872 block will not be exported.
12873 @item :exports both
12874 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12875 @item :exports none
12876 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12877 @end table
12878
12879 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12880 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12881 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12882 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12883 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12884 markup language for a wiki.
12885
12886 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12887 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12888 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12889 @section Extracting source code
12890 @cindex tangling
12891 @cindex source code, extracting
12892 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12893
12894 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12895 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12896 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12897 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12898 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12899
12900 @subsubheading Header arguments
12901 @table @code
12902 @item :tangle no
12903 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12904 @item :tangle yes
12905 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12906 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12907 for the block language.
12908 @item :tangle filename
12909 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12910 @end table
12911
12912 @kindex C-c C-v t
12913 @subsubheading Functions
12914 @table @code
12915 @item org-babel-tangle
12916 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12917 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12918 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12919 @end table
12920
12921 @subsubheading Hooks
12922 @table @code
12923 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12924 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12925 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12926 of tangled code files.
12927 @end table
12928
12929 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12930 @section Evaluating code blocks
12931 @cindex code block, evaluating
12932 @cindex source code, evaluating
12933 @cindex #+RESULTS
12934
12935 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12936 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12937 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12938 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12939 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12940 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12941 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12942 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12943 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12944 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12945
12946 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12947 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12948 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12949 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12950 used to define a code block).
12951
12952 @kindex C-c C-c
12953 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12954 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12955 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12956 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12957 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12958 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12959 @cindex #+CALL
12960
12961 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12962 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12963 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12964 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12965 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12966
12967 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12968
12969 @example
12970 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12971 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12972 @end example
12973
12974 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12975
12976 @example
12977 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12978 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12979 @end example
12980
12981 @table @code
12982 @item <name>
12983 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12984 @item <arguments>
12985 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12986 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12987 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12988 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12989 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12990 @item <inside header arguments>
12991 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12992 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12993 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12994 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12995 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12996 @item <end header arguments>
12997 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12998 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12999 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
13000 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
13001 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
13002
13003 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13004 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13005 @end table
13006
13007 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13008 @section Library of Babel
13009 @cindex babel, library of
13010 @cindex source code, library
13011 @cindex code block, library
13012
13013 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13014 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13015 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13016 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13017
13018
13019 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13020 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13021
13022 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13023 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13024 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13025
13026
13027 @kindex C-c C-v i
13028 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13029 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13030 i}.
13031
13032 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13033 @section Languages
13034 @cindex babel, languages
13035 @cindex source code, languages
13036 @cindex code block, languages
13037
13038 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13039
13040 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13041 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13042 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13043 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13044 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13045 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13046 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13047 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13048 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13049 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13050 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13051 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13052 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13053 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13054 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13055 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13056 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13057 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13058 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13059 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13060 @end multitable
13061
13062 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13063 available, it can be found at
13064 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13065
13066 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13067 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13068 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13069 to your emacs configuration.
13070
13071 @quotation
13072 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13073 @code{R} code blocks.
13074 @end quotation
13075
13076 @lisp
13077 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13078 'org-babel-load-languages
13079 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13080 (R . t)))
13081 @end lisp
13082
13083 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13084 elisp file with @code{require}.
13085
13086 @quotation
13087 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13088 @end quotation
13089
13090 @lisp
13091 (require 'ob-clojure)
13092 @end lisp
13093
13094 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13095 @section Header arguments
13096 @cindex code block, header arguments
13097 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13098
13099 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13100 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13101 describes each header argument in detail.
13102
13103 @menu
13104 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13105 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13106 @end menu
13107
13108 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13109 @subsection Using header arguments
13110
13111 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13112 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13113 @menu
13114 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13115 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13116 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13117 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13118 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13119 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13120 @end menu
13121
13122
13123 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13124 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13125 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13126 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13127 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13128
13129 @example
13130 :session => "none"
13131 :results => "replace"
13132 :exports => "code"
13133 :cache => "no"
13134 :noweb => "no"
13135 @end example
13136
13137 @c @example
13138 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13139 @c Its value is
13140 @c ((:session . "none")
13141 @c (:results . "replace")
13142 @c (:exports . "code")
13143 @c (:cache . "no")
13144 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13145
13146
13147 @c Documentation:
13148 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13149 @c @end example
13150
13151 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13152 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13153 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13154 blocks.
13155
13156 @lisp
13157 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13158 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13159 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13160 @end lisp
13161
13162 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13163 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13164 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13165 language-specific documentation available online at
13166 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13167
13168 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13169 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13170 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13171 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13172 @ref{Property syntax}).
13173
13174 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13175 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13176 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13177 inserted into the buffer.
13178
13179 @example
13180 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13181 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13182 @end example
13183
13184 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13185 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13186
13187 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13188 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13189 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13190
13191 @example
13192 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13193 @end example
13194
13195 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13196 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13197 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13198 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13199 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13200 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13201
13202 @example
13203 * outline header
13204 :PROPERTIES:
13205 :cache: yes
13206 :END:
13207 @end example
13208
13209 @kindex C-c C-x p
13210 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13211 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13212 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13213 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13214 in Org mode documents.
13215
13216 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13217 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13218
13219 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13220 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13221 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13222 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13223 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13224 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13225 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13226 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13227 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13228 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13229
13230 @example
13231 #+NAME: factorial
13232 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13233 fac 0 = 1
13234 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13235 #+END_SRC
13236 @end example
13237 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13238
13239 @example
13240 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13241 @end example
13242
13243 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13244 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13245 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13246 @cindex #+HEADER:
13247 @cindex #+HEADERS:
13248
13249 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13250 @example
13251 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13252 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13253 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13254 #+END_SRC
13255
13256 #+RESULTS:
13257 : data1:1, data2:2
13258 @end example
13259
13260 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13261 @example
13262 #+NAME: named-block
13263 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13264 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13265 (message "data:%S" data)
13266 #+END_SRC
13267
13268 #+RESULTS: named-block
13269 : data:2
13270 @end example
13271
13272 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13273 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13274 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13275
13276 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13277 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13278 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13279 blocks}.
13280
13281 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13282 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13283 @example
13284 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13285 @end example
13286
13287 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13288 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13289 @example
13290 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13291 @end example
13292
13293 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13294 @subsection Specific header arguments
13295 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13296 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13297
13298 @menu
13299 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13300 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13301 be collected and handled
13302 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13303 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13304 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13305 directory for code block execution
13306 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13307 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13308 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13309 files during tangling
13310 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13311 code files
13312 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13313 code files
13314 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13315 expansion during tangling
13316 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13317 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13318 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13319 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13320 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13321 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13322 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13323 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13324 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13325 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13326 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13327 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13328 @end menu
13329
13330 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13331 @ref{Languages}.
13332
13333 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13334 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13335 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13336 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13337 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13338 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13339 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13340
13341 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13342 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13343 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13344 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13345 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13346 code blocks.
13347
13348 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13349 Indexable variable values}).
13350
13351 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13352 @code{:var} header argument.
13353
13354 @example
13355 :var name=assign
13356 @end example
13357
13358 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13359 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13360 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13361 results of evaluating another code block.
13362
13363 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13364
13365 @table @dfn
13366
13367 @item table
13368 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13369 @example
13370 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13371 | 1 |
13372 | 2 |
13373 | 3 |
13374 | 4 |
13375
13376 #+NAME: table-length
13377 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13378 (length table)
13379 #+END_SRC
13380
13381 #+RESULTS: table-length
13382 : 4
13383 @end example
13384
13385 @item list
13386 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13387 carried through to the source code block)
13388
13389 @example
13390 #+NAME: example-list
13391 - simple
13392 - not
13393 - nested
13394 - list
13395
13396 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13397 (print x)
13398 #+END_SRC
13399
13400 #+RESULTS:
13401 | simple | list |
13402 @end example
13403
13404 @item code block without arguments
13405 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13406 optionally followed by parentheses
13407
13408 @example
13409 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13410 (* 2 length)
13411 #+END_SRC
13412
13413 #+RESULTS:
13414 : 8
13415 @end example
13416
13417 @item code block with arguments
13418 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13419 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13420 code block name using standard function call syntax
13421
13422 @example
13423 #+NAME: double
13424 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13425 (* 2 input)
13426 #+END_SRC
13427
13428 #+RESULTS: double
13429 : 16
13430
13431 #+NAME: squared
13432 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13433 (* input input)
13434 #+END_SRC
13435
13436 #+RESULTS: squared
13437 : 4
13438 @end example
13439
13440 @item literal example
13441 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13442
13443 @example
13444 #+NAME: literal-example
13445 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
13446 A literal example
13447 on two lines
13448 #+END_EXAMPLE
13449
13450 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13451 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13452 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13453 #+END_SRC
13454
13455 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13456 : A literal example
13457 : on two lines for you.
13458
13459 @end example
13460
13461 @end table
13462
13463 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13464 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13465 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13466 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13467 following the source name.
13468
13469 @example
13470 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13471 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13472 (* 2 (+ input x))
13473 #+END_SRC
13474 @end example
13475
13476 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13477 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13478 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13479 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13480 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13481 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13482 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13483 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13484 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13485
13486 @example
13487 #+NAME: example-table
13488 | 1 | a |
13489 | 2 | b |
13490 | 3 | c |
13491 | 4 | d |
13492
13493 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13494 data
13495 #+END_SRC
13496
13497 #+RESULTS:
13498 : a
13499 @end example
13500
13501 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13502 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13503 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13504 to @code{data}.
13505
13506 @example
13507 #+NAME: example-table
13508 | 1 | a |
13509 | 2 | b |
13510 | 3 | c |
13511 | 4 | d |
13512 | 5 | 3 |
13513
13514 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13515 data
13516 #+END_SRC
13517
13518 #+RESULTS:
13519 | 2 | b |
13520 | 3 | c |
13521 | 4 | d |
13522 @end example
13523
13524 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13525 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13526 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13527 column is referenced.
13528
13529 @example
13530 #+NAME: example-table
13531 | 1 | a |
13532 | 2 | b |
13533 | 3 | c |
13534 | 4 | d |
13535
13536 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13537 data
13538 #+END_SRC
13539
13540 #+RESULTS:
13541 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
13542 @end example
13543
13544 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13545 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13546 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13547
13548 @example
13549 #+NAME: 3D
13550 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13551 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13552 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13553 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13554 #+END_SRC
13555
13556 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13557 data
13558 #+END_SRC
13559
13560 #+RESULTS:
13561 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
13562 @end example
13563
13564 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13565
13566 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13567 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13568 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13569 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13570 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13571 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13572 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13573 evaluation of the code block body.
13574
13575 @example
13576 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13577 wc -w $filename
13578 #+END_SRC
13579 @end example
13580
13581 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13582 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13583
13584 @example
13585 #+NAME: table
13586 | (a b c) |
13587
13588 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13589 #+BEGIN_SRC perl
13590 $data
13591 #+END_SRC
13592
13593 #+RESULTS:
13594 : (a b c)
13595 @end example
13596
13597 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13598 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13599
13600 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13601 per class may be supplied per code block.
13602
13603 @itemize @bullet
13604 @item
13605 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13606 from the code block
13607 @item
13608 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13609 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13610 Org mode buffer
13611 @item
13612 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13613 block should be handled.
13614 @end itemize
13615
13616 @subsubheading Collection
13617 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13618 should be collected from the code block.
13619
13620 @itemize @bullet
13621 @item @code{value}
13622 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13623 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13624 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13625 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13626 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13627 @item @code{output}
13628 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13629 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13630 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13631 @end itemize
13632
13633 @subsubheading Type
13634
13635 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13636 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13637 table or scalar depending on their value.
13638
13639 @itemize @bullet
13640 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13641 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13642 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13643 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13644 @item @code{list}
13645 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13646 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13647 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13648 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13649 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13650 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13651 @item @code{file}
13652 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13653 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13654 @item @code{raw}
13655 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13656 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13657 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13658 @item @code{org}
13659 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13660 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13661 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13662 @item @code{html}
13663 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13664 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13665 @item @code{latex}
13666 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13667 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13668 @item @code{code}
13669 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13670 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13671 @item @code{pp}
13672 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13673 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13674 @code{:results value pp}.
13675 @item @code{drawer}
13676 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13677 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13678 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13679 @end itemize
13680
13681 @subsubheading Handling
13682 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13683 results once they are collected.
13684
13685 @itemize @bullet
13686 @item @code{silent}
13687 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13688 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13689 @item @code{replace}
13690 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13691 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13692 @code{:results output replace}.
13693 @item @code{append}
13694 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13695 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13696 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13697 @item @code{prepend}
13698 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13699 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13700 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13701 @end itemize
13702
13703 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13704 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13705
13706 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13707 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13708 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13709 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13710 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13711 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13712 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13713 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13714
13715 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13716 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13717 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13718
13719 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13720 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13721
13722 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13723 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13724 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13725 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13726 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13727
13728 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13729 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13730
13731 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13732 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13733 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13734 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13735 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13736 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13737 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13738
13739 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13740 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13741 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13742
13743 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13744 in your home directory, you could use
13745
13746 @example
13747 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13748 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13749 #+END_SRC
13750 @end example
13751
13752 @subsubheading Remote execution
13753 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13754 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13755
13756 @example
13757 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13758 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13759 #+END_SRC
13760 @end example
13761
13762 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13763 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13764 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13765 created.
13766
13767 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13768 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13769
13770 @example
13771 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13772 @end example
13773
13774 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13775 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13776 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13777 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13778
13779 @subsubheading Further points
13780
13781 @itemize @bullet
13782 @item
13783 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13784 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13785 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13786 @item
13787 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13788 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13789 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13790 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13791 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13792 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13793 which the link does not point.
13794 @end itemize
13795
13796 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13797 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13798
13799 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13800 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13801
13802 @itemize @bullet
13803 @item @code{code}
13804 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13805 @code{:exports code}.
13806 @item @code{results}
13807 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13808 @code{:exports results}.
13809 @item @code{both}
13810 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13811 @code{:exports both}.
13812 @item @code{none}
13813 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13814 @end itemize
13815
13816 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13817 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13818
13819 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13820 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13821
13822 @itemize @bullet
13823 @item @code{tangle}
13824 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13825 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13826 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13827 @item @code{no}
13828 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13829 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13830 @item other
13831 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13832 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13833 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13834 @end itemize
13835
13836 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13837 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13838
13839 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13840 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13841 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13842
13843 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13844 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13845 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13846 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13847 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13848 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13849
13850 @itemize @bullet
13851 @item @code{no}
13852 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13853 @item @code{link}
13854 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13855 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13856 @item @code{yes}
13857 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13858 @item @code{org}
13859 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13860
13861 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13862 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13863 @item @code{both}
13864 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13865 @item @code{noweb}
13866 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13867 references in the code block body in link comments.
13868 @end itemize
13869
13870 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13871 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13872 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13873 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13874 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13875 are accepted.
13876
13877 @itemize @bullet
13878 @item @code{yes}
13879 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13880 @item @code{no}
13881 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13882 @end itemize
13883
13884 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13885 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13886
13887 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13888 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13889 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13890 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13891 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13892
13893 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13894 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13895
13896 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13897 language where state is preserved.
13898
13899 By default, a session is not started.
13900
13901 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13902 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13903 interpreted language.
13904
13905 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13906 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13907
13908 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13909 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13910 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13911 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13912 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13913
13914 @itemize @bullet
13915 @item @code{no}
13916 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13917 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13918 @item @code{yes}
13919 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13920 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13921 @item @code{tangle}
13922 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13923 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13924 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13925 @item @code{no-export}
13926 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13927 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13928 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13929 @item @code{strip-export}
13930 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13931 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13932 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13933 @item @code{eval}
13934 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13935 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13936 @end itemize
13937
13938 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13939 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13940 @code{<<reference>>}.
13941 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13942 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13943 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13944
13945 This code block:
13946
13947 @example
13948 -- <<example>>
13949 @end example
13950
13951
13952 expands to:
13953
13954 @example
13955 -- this is the
13956 -- multi-line body of example
13957 @end example
13958
13959 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13960 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13961 references.
13962
13963 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13964 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13965 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13966 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13967 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13968 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13969
13970 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13971 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13972 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13973 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13974 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13975 inheritance}).}.
13976
13977 @example
13978 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13979 <<fullest-disk>>
13980 #+END_SRC
13981 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13982 :PROPERTIES:
13983 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13984 :END:
13985
13986 ** query all mounted disks
13987 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13988 df \
13989 #+END_SRC
13990
13991 ** strip the header row
13992 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13993 |sed '1d' \
13994 #+END_SRC
13995
13996 ** sort by the percent full
13997 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13998 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13999 #+END_SRC
14000
14001 ** extract the mount point
14002 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14003 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14004 #+END_SRC
14005 @end example
14006
14007 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14008 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14009 newline is used.
14010
14011 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14012 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14013
14014 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14015 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14016 used.
14017
14018 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14019 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14020
14021 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14022 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14023 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14024 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14025 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14026 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14027 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14028
14029 @itemize @bullet
14030 @item @code{no}
14031 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14032 every time it is called.
14033 @item @code{yes}
14034 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14035 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14036 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14037 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14038 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14039 @end itemize
14040
14041 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14042 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14043 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14044 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14045 changed since it was last run.
14046
14047 @example
14048 #+NAME: random
14049 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14050 runif(1)
14051 #+END_SRC
14052
14053 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14054 0.4659510825295
14055
14056 #+NAME: caller
14057 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14058 x
14059 #+END_SRC
14060
14061 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14062 0.254227238707244
14063 @end example
14064
14065 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14066 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14067
14068 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14069 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14070 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14071 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14072 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14073 header argument.
14074
14075 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14076 delimited.
14077
14078 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14079 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14080
14081 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14082 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14083 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14084
14085 @itemize @bullet
14086 @item @code{no}
14087 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14088 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14089 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14090 default value yields the following results.
14091
14092 @example
14093 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14094 | a | b | c |
14095 |---+---+---|
14096 | d | e | f |
14097 |---+---+---|
14098 | g | h | i |
14099
14100 #+NAME: echo-table
14101 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14102 return tab
14103 #+END_SRC
14104
14105 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14106 | a | b | c |
14107 | d | e | f |
14108 | g | h | i |
14109 @end example
14110
14111 @item @code{yes}
14112 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14113
14114 @example
14115 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14116 | a | b | c |
14117 |---+---+---|
14118 | d | e | f |
14119 |---+---+---|
14120 | g | h | i |
14121
14122 #+NAME: echo-table
14123 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14124 return tab
14125 #+END_SRC
14126
14127 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14128 | a | b | c |
14129 |---+---+---|
14130 | d | e | f |
14131 |---+---+---|
14132 | g | h | i |
14133 @end example
14134 @end itemize
14135
14136 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14137 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14138
14139 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14140 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14141 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14142 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14143 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14144 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14145
14146 @itemize @bullet
14147 @item @code{nil}
14148 If an input table looks like it has column names
14149 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14150 names will be removed from the table before
14151 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14152
14153 @example
14154 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14155 | a |
14156 |---|
14157 | b |
14158 | c |
14159
14160 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14161 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14162 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14163 #+END_SRC
14164
14165 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14166 | a |
14167 |----|
14168 | b* |
14169 | c* |
14170 @end example
14171
14172 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14173 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14174
14175 @item @code{no}
14176 No column name pre-processing takes place
14177
14178 @item @code{yes}
14179 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14180 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14181 hline)
14182 @end itemize
14183
14184 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14185 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14186
14187 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14188 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14189
14190 @itemize @bullet
14191 @item @code{no}
14192 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14193
14194 @item @code{yes}
14195 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14196 and is then reapplied to the results.
14197
14198 @example
14199 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14200 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14201 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14202
14203 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14204 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14205 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14206 #+END_SRC
14207
14208 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14209 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14210 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14211 @end example
14212
14213 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14214 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14215
14216 @end itemize
14217
14218 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14219 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14220
14221 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14222 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14223 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14224 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14225
14226 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14227 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14228 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14229 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14230 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14231 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14232 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14233 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14234
14235 @table @code
14236 @item never or no
14237 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14238 @item query
14239 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14240 @item never-export or no-export
14241 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14242 interactively.
14243 @item query-export
14244 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14245 @end table
14246
14247 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14248 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14249 security}.
14250
14251 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14252 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14253 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14254 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14255 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14256 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14257 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14258
14259 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14260 @section Results of evaluation
14261 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14262 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14263
14264 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14265 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14266 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14267 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14268
14269 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14270 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14271 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14272 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14273 @end multitable
14274
14275 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14276 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14277 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14278
14279 @subsection Non-session
14280 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14281 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14282 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14283 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14284 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14285 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14286 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14287
14288 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14289 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14290
14291 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14292 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14293 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14294 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14295 future work.)
14296
14297 @subsection Session
14298 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14299 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14300 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14301 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14302 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14303 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14304 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14305 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14306
14307 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14308 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14309 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14310 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14311 in R).
14312
14313 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14314 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14315 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14316 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14317 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14318 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14319 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14320
14321 @example
14322 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14323 print "hello"
14324 2
14325 print "bye"
14326 #+END_SRC
14327
14328 #+RESULTS:
14329 : hello
14330 : bye
14331 @end example
14332
14333 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14334 @example
14335 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14336 print "hello"
14337 2
14338 print "bye"
14339 #+END_SRC
14340
14341 #+RESULTS:
14342 : hello
14343 : 2
14344 : bye
14345 @end example
14346
14347 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14348 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14349 unnecessary here).
14350
14351 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14352 @section Noweb reference syntax
14353 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14354 @cindex syntax, noweb
14355 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14356
14357 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14358 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14359 familiar Noweb syntax:
14360
14361 @example
14362 <<code-block-name>>
14363 @end example
14364
14365 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14366 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14367 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14368 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14369 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14370 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14371
14372 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14373 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14374 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14375
14376 @example
14377 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14378 @end example
14379
14380 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14381 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14382 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14383 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14384 the default value.
14385
14386 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14387 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14388 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14389 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14390 argument.
14391
14392 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14393 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14394 @cindex code block, key bindings
14395
14396 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14397 the context.
14398
14399 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14400 are active:
14401
14402 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14403 @kindex C-c C-c
14404 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14405 @kindex C-c C-o
14406 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14407 @kindex C-up
14408 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14409 @kindex M-down
14410 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14411 @end multitable
14412
14413 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14414
14415 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14416 @kindex C-c C-v p
14417 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14418 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14419 @kindex C-c C-v n
14420 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14421 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14422 @kindex C-c C-v e
14423 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14424 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14425 @kindex C-c C-v o
14426 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14427 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14428 @kindex C-c C-v v
14429 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14430 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14431 @kindex C-c C-v u
14432 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14433 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14434 @kindex C-c C-v g
14435 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14436 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14437 @kindex C-c C-v r
14438 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14439 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14440 @kindex C-c C-v b
14441 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14442 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14443 @kindex C-c C-v s
14444 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14445 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14446 @kindex C-c C-v d
14447 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14448 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14449 @kindex C-c C-v t
14450 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14451 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14452 @kindex C-c C-v f
14453 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14454 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14455 @kindex C-c C-v c
14456 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14457 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14458 @kindex C-c C-v j
14459 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14460 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14461 @kindex C-c C-v l
14462 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14463 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14464 @kindex C-c C-v i
14465 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14466 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14467 @kindex C-c C-v I
14468 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14469 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14470 @kindex C-c C-v z
14471 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14472 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14473 @kindex C-c C-v a
14474 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14475 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14476 @kindex C-c C-v h
14477 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14478 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14479 @kindex C-c C-v x
14480 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14481 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14482 @end multitable
14483
14484 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14485 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14486
14487 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14488 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14489 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14490 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14491 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14492 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14493 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14494 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14495 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14496 @c @end multitable
14497
14498 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14499 @section Batch execution
14500 @cindex code block, batch execution
14501 @cindex source code, batch execution
14502
14503 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14504 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14505
14506 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14507
14508 @example
14509 #!/bin/sh
14510 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14511 #
14512 # tangle files with org-mode
14513 #
14514 DIR=`pwd`
14515 FILES=""
14516
14517 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14518 for i in $@@; do
14519 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14520 done
14521
14522 emacs -Q --batch \
14523 --eval "(progn
14524 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14525 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14526 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14527 (mapc (lambda (file)
14528 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14529 (org-babel-tangle)
14530 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14531 @end example
14532
14533 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14534 @chapter Miscellaneous
14535
14536 @menu
14537 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14538 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14539 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14540 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14541 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14542 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14543 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14544 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14545 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14546 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14547 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14548 @end menu
14549
14550
14551 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14552 @section Completion
14553 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14554 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14555 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14556 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14557 @cindex completion, of tags
14558 @cindex completion, of property keys
14559 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14560 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14561 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14562 @cindex dictionary word completion
14563 @cindex option keyword completion
14564 @cindex tag completion
14565 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14566
14567 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14568 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14569 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14570 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14571 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14572
14573 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14574 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14575 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14576
14577 @table @kbd
14578 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14579 @item M-@key{TAB}
14580 Complete word at point
14581 @itemize @bullet
14582 @item
14583 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14584 @item
14585 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14586 @item
14587 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14588 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14589 @item
14590 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14591 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14592 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14593 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14594 @item
14595 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14596 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14597 buffer.
14598 @item
14599 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14600 @item
14601 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14602 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14603 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14604 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14605 @item
14606 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14607 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14608 @item
14609 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14610 @end itemize
14611 @end table
14612
14613 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14614 @section Easy Templates
14615 @cindex template insertion
14616 @cindex insertion, of templates
14617
14618 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14619 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14620 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14621 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14622 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14623
14624 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14625 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14626 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14627
14628 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14629
14630 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14631 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14632 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14633 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14634 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14635 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14636 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14637 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14638 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14639 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14640 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14641 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14642 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14643 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14644 @end multitable
14645
14646 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14647 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14648
14649 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14650 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14651 additional details.
14652
14653 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14654 @section Speed keys
14655 @cindex speed keys
14656 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14657 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14658
14659 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14660 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14661 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14662 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14663 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14664 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14665 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14666 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14667
14668 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14669 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14670
14671 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14672 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14673
14674 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14675
14676 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14677 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14678 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14679 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14680 these precautions intact.
14681
14682 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14683 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14684 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14685
14686 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14687
14688 @table @i
14689 @item Source code blocks
14690 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14691 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14692 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14693 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14694 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14695
14696 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14697 which take off the default security brakes.
14698
14699 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14700 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14701 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14702 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14703 ask and nil not to ask.
14704 @end defopt
14705
14706 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14707 without asking:
14708 @example
14709 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14710 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14711 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14712 @end example
14713
14714 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14715 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14716 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14717 not visible.
14718
14719 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14720 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14721 @end defopt
14722 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14723 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14724 @end defopt
14725
14726 @item Formulas in tables
14727 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14728 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14729 @end table
14730
14731 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14732 @section Customization
14733 @cindex customization
14734 @cindex options, for customization
14735 @cindex variables, for customization
14736
14737 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14738 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14739 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14740 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14741 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14742 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14743 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14744
14745 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14746 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14747 @cindex in-buffer settings
14748 @cindex special keywords
14749
14750 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14751 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14752 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14753 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14754 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14755 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14756 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14757 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14758 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14759
14760 @vindex org-archive-location
14761 @table @kbd
14762 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14763 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14764 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14765 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14766 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14767 @item #+CATEGORY:
14768 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14769 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14770 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14771 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14772 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14773 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14774 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14775 applies.
14776 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14777 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14778 @vindex org-table-formula
14779 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14780 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14781 The global version of this variable is
14782 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14783 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14784 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14785 top-level entries.
14786 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14787 @vindex org-drawers
14788 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14789 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14790 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14791 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14792 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14793 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14794 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14795 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14796 @vindex org-highest-priority
14797 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14798 @vindex org-default-priority
14799 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14800 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14801 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14802 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14803 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14804 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14805 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14806 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14807 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14808 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14809 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14810 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14811 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14812 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14813 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14814 @item #+STARTUP:
14815 @cindex #+STARTUP:
14816 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14817 Org file is being visited.
14818
14819 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14820 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14821 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14822 @code{overview}.
14823 @vindex org-startup-folded
14824 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14825 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14826 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14827 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14828 @example
14829 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14830 content @r{all headlines}
14831 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14832 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14833 @end example
14834
14835 @vindex org-startup-indented
14836 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14837 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14838 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14839 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14840 @example
14841 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14842 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14843 @end example
14844
14845 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14846 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14847 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14848 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14849 @code{nil}.
14850 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14851 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14852 @example
14853 align @r{align all tables}
14854 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14855 @end example
14856
14857 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14858 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14859 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14860 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14861 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14862 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14863 @example
14864 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14865 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14866 @end example
14867
14868 @vindex org-log-done
14869 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14870 @vindex org-log-repeat
14871 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14872 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14873 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14874 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14875 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14876 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14877 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14878 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14879 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14880 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14881 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14883 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14884 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14885 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14888 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14889 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14890 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14891 @example
14892 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14893 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14894 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14895 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14896 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14897 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14898 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14899 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14900 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14901 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14902 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14903 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14904 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14905 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14906 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14907 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14908 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14909 @end example
14910 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14911 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14912 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14913 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14914 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14915 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14916 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14917 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14918 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14919 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14920 @example
14921 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14922 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14923 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14924 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14925 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14926 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14927 @end example
14928 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14929 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14930 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14931 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14932 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14933 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14934 @example
14935 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14936 @end example
14937 @vindex constants-unit-system
14938 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14939 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14940 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14941 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14942 @example
14943 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14944 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14945 @end example
14946 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14947 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14948 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14949 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14950 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14951 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14952 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14953 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14954 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14955 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14956 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14957 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14958 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14959 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14960 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14961 @example
14962 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14963 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14964 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14965 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14966 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14967 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14968 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14969 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14970 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14971 @end example
14972 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14973 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14974 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14975 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14976 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14977 @example
14978 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14979 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14980 @end example
14981 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14982 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14983 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14984 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14985 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14986 @example
14987 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14988 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14989 @end example
14990 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14991 @vindex org-tag-alist
14992 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14993 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14994 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14995 @item #+TBLFM:
14996 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14997 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14998 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14999 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
15000 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
15001 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
15002 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15003 @ref{Export options}.
15004 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15005 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15006 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15007 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15008 @end table
15009
15010 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15011 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15012 @kindex C-c C-c
15013 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15014
15015 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15016 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15017 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15018 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15019 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15020 what this means in different contexts.
15021
15022 @itemize @minus
15023 @item
15024 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15025 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15026 @item
15027 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15028 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15029 information.
15030 @item
15031 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15032 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15033 @item
15034 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15035 the entire table.
15036 @item
15037 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15038 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15039 default location.
15040 @item
15041 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15042 corresponding links in this buffer.
15043 @item
15044 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15045 drawer, offer property commands.
15046 @item
15047 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15048 definition, and vice versa.
15049 @item
15050 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15051 @item
15052 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15053 of the checkbox.
15054 @item
15055 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15056 ordered list.
15057 @item
15058 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15059 block is updated.
15060 @item
15061 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15062 @end itemize
15063
15064 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15065 @section A cleaner outline view
15066 @cindex hiding leading stars
15067 @cindex dynamic indentation
15068 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15069 @cindex clean outline view
15070
15071 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15072 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15073 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15074 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15075 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15076
15077 @example
15078 @group
15079 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15080 ** Second level | * Second level
15081 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15082 some text | some text
15083 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15084 more text | more text
15085 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15086 @end group
15087 @end example
15088
15089 @noindent
15090
15091 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15092 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15093 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15094 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15095 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15096 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15097 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15098 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15099 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15100 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15101 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15102 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15103 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15104 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15105 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15106 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15107 individual files using
15108
15109 @example
15110 #+STARTUP: indent
15111 @end example
15112
15113 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15114 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15115 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15116 the following way:
15117
15118 @enumerate
15119 @item
15120 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15121 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15122 with the headline, like
15123
15124 @example
15125 *** 3rd level
15126 more text, now indented
15127 @end example
15128
15129 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15130 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15131 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15132 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15133
15134 @item
15135 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15136 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15137 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15138 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15139 with
15140
15141 @example
15142 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15143 #+STARTUP: showstars
15144 @end example
15145
15146 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15147
15148 @example
15149 @group
15150 * Top level headline
15151 * Second level
15152 * 3rd level
15153 ...
15154 @end group
15155 @end example
15156
15157 @noindent
15158 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15159 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15160 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15161 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15162 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15163 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15164 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15165
15166 @item
15167 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15168 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15169 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15170 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15171 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15172 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15173 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15174 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15175 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15176
15177 @example
15178 #+STARTUP: odd
15179 #+STARTUP: oddeven
15180 @end example
15181
15182 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15183 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15184 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15185 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15186 @end enumerate
15187
15188 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15189 @section Using Org on a tty
15190 @cindex tty key bindings
15191
15192 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15193 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15194 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15195 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15196 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15197 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15198 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15199 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15200 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15201 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15202 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15203
15204 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15205 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15206 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15207 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15208 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15209 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15210 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15211 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15212 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15213 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15214 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15215 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15216 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15217 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15218 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15219 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15220 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15221 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15222 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15223 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15224 @end multitable
15225
15226
15227 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15228 @section Interaction with other packages
15229 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15230 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15231 with other code out there.
15232
15233 @menu
15234 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15235 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15236 @end menu
15237
15238 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15239 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15240
15241 @table @asis
15242 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15243 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15244 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15245 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15246 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15247 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15248 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15249 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15250 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15251 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15252 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15253 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15254 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15255 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15256 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15257 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15258 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15259 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15260 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15261 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15262 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15263 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15264 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15265 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15266 @file{constants.el}.
15267 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15268 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15269 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15270 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15271 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15272 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15273 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15274 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15275 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15276 @lisp
15277 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15278 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15279 @end lisp
15280 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15281 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15282 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15283 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15284 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15285 @cindex Wiegley, John
15286 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15287 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15288 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15289 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15290 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15291 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15292 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15293 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15294 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15295 @cindex @file{table.el}
15296 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15297 @kindex C-c C-c
15298 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15299 @cindex @file{table.el}
15300 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15301
15302 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15303 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15304 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15305 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15306 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15307 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15308 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15309
15310 @table @kbd
15311 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15312 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15313 @c
15314 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15315 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15316 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15317 format. See the documentation string of the command
15318 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15319 possible.
15320 @end table
15321 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15322 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15323 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15324 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15325 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15326 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15327 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15328 @end table
15329
15330 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15331 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15332
15333 @table @asis
15334
15335 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15336 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15337 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15338 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15339 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15340 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15341 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15342 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15343 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15344 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15345 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15346 cursor moves across a special context.
15347
15348 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15349 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15350 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15351 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15352 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15353 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15354 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15355 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15356 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15357 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15358 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15359 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15360 buffer (but not during date selection).
15361
15362 @example
15363 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15364 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15365 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15366 @end example
15367
15368 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15369 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15370 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15371 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15372
15373 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15374 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15375
15376 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15377 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15378 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15379 this:
15380
15381 @lisp
15382 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15383 @end lisp
15384
15385 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15386 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15387 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15388 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15389 fixed this problem:
15390
15391 @lisp
15392 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15393 (lambda ()
15394 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15395 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15396 @end lisp
15397
15398 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15399 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15400 function:
15401
15402 @lisp
15403 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15404 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15405 @end lisp
15406
15407 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15408
15409 @lisp
15410 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15411 (lambda ()
15412 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15413 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15414 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15415 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15416 @end lisp
15417
15418 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15419 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15420 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15421 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15422 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15423 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15424 configuration:
15425
15426 @lisp
15427 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15428 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15429 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15430 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15431 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15432 @end lisp
15433
15434 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15435 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15436 @kindex C-c /
15437 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15438 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15439 another key for this command, or override the key in
15440 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15441
15442 @lisp
15443 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15444 @end lisp
15445
15446 @end table
15447
15448 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15449 @section org-crypt.el
15450 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15451 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15452
15453 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15454 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15455 files.
15456
15457 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15458 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15459 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15460
15461 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15462 @file{.emacs}:
15463
15464 @example
15465 (require 'org-crypt)
15466 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15467 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15468
15469 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15470 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15471 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15472
15473 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15474 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15475 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15476 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15477 ;; start Org.
15478
15479 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15480 ;;
15481 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15482 @end example
15483
15484 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15485 being encrypted again.
15486
15487 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15488 @appendix Hacking
15489 @cindex hacking
15490
15491 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15492 Org.
15493
15494 @menu
15495 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15496 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15497 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15498 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15499 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15500 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15501 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15502 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15503 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15504 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15505 @end menu
15506
15507 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15508 @section Hooks
15509 @cindex hooks
15510
15511 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15512 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15513 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15514 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15515 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15516
15517 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15518 @section Add-on packages
15519 @cindex add-on packages
15520
15521 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15522 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15523 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15524 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15525 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15526 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15527
15528
15529
15530 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15531 @section Adding hyperlink types
15532 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15533
15534 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15535 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15536 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15537 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15538 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15539 Emacs:
15540
15541 @lisp
15542 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15543
15544 (require 'org)
15545
15546 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15547 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15548
15549 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15550 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15551 :group 'org-link
15552 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15553
15554 (defun org-man-open (path)
15555 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15556 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15557 (funcall org-man-command path))
15558
15559 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15560 "Store a link to a manpage."
15561 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15562 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15563 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15564 (link (concat "man:" page))
15565 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15566 (org-store-link-props
15567 :type "man"
15568 :link link
15569 :description description))))
15570
15571 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15572 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15573 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15574 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15575 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15576 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15577
15578 (provide 'org-man)
15579
15580 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15581 @end lisp
15582
15583 @noindent
15584 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15585
15586 @lisp
15587 (require 'org-man)
15588 @end lisp
15589
15590 @noindent
15591 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15592 @enumerate
15593 @item
15594 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15595 loaded.
15596 @item
15597 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15598 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15599 that will be called to follow such a link.
15600 @item
15601 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15602 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15603 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15604 buffer displaying a man page.
15605 @end enumerate
15606
15607 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15608 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15609 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15610 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15611 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15612 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15613 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15614
15615 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15616 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15617 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15618 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15619 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15620 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15621 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15622 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15623 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15624 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15625 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15626 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15627
15628 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15629 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15630 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15631 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15632
15633 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15634 @section Context-sensitive commands
15635 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15636 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15637 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15638
15639 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15640 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15641 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15642
15643 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15644 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15645 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15646 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15647 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15648 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15649 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15650 @code{#+RR:}.
15651
15652 @lisp
15653 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15654 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15655 (if (save-excursion
15656 (beginning-of-line 1)
15657 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15658 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15659 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15660 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15661
15662 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15663 @end lisp
15664
15665 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15666 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15667 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15668 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15669 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15670
15671
15672 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15673 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15674 @cindex tables, in other modes
15675 @cindex lists, in other modes
15676 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15677
15678 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15679 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15680 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15681 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15682 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15683 editor.
15684
15685 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15686 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15687 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15688 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15689 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15690 for a very flexible system.
15691
15692 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15693 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15694 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15695 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15696
15697
15698 @menu
15699 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15700 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15701 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15702 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15703 @end menu
15704
15705 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15706 @subsection Radio tables
15707 @cindex radio tables
15708
15709 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15710 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15711 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15712 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15713
15714 @example
15715 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15716 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15717 @end example
15718
15719 @noindent
15720 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15721 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15722 example:
15723 @cindex #+ORGTBL
15724 @example
15725 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15726 @end example
15727
15728 @noindent
15729 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15730 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15731 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15732 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15733 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15734 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15735 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15736
15737 @table @code
15738 @item :skip N
15739 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15740 this parameter!
15741
15742 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15743 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15744 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15745 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15746 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15747 additional columns.
15748
15749 @item :no-escape t
15750 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15751 the table. The default value is nil.
15752 @end table
15753
15754 @noindent
15755 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15756 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15757 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15758 number of different solutions:
15759
15760 @itemize @bullet
15761 @item
15762 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15763 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15764 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15765 @item
15766 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15767 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15768 in @LaTeX{}.
15769 @item
15770 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15771 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15772 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15773 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15774 key.
15775 @end itemize
15776
15777 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15778 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15779 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15780
15781 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15782 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15783 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15784 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15785 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15786 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15787 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15788 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15789 will then get the following template:
15790
15791 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15792 @example
15793 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15794 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15795 \begin@{comment@}
15796 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15797 | | |
15798 \end@{comment@}
15799 @end example
15800
15801 @noindent
15802 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15803 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15804 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15805 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15806 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15807 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15808 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15809 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15810 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15811 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15812 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15813 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15814
15815 @example
15816 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15817 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15818 \begin@{comment@}
15819 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15820 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15821 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15822 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15823 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15824 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15825 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15826 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15827 \end@{comment@}
15828 @end example
15829
15830 @noindent
15831 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15832 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15833
15834 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15835 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15836 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15837 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15838 header and footer commands of the target table:
15839
15840 @example
15841 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15842 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15843 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15844 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15845 \end@{tabular@}
15846 %
15847 \begin@{comment@}
15848 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15849 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15850 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15851 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15852 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15853 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15854 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15855 \end@{comment@}
15856 @end example
15857
15858 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15859 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15860 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15861 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15862
15863 @table @code
15864 @item :splice nil/t
15865 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15866 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15867
15868 @item :fmt fmt
15869 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15870 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15871 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15872 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15873 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15874 function must return a formatted string.
15875
15876 @item :efmt efmt
15877 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15878 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15879 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15880 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15881 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15882 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15883 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15884 supplied instead of strings.
15885 @end table
15886
15887 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15888 @subsection Translator functions
15889 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15890 @cindex translator function
15891
15892 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15893 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15894 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15895 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15896 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15897 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15898 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15899 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15900 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15901
15902 @lisp
15903 @group
15904 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15905 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15906 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15907 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15908 (params2
15909 (list
15910 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15911 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15912 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15913 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15914 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15915 @end group
15916 @end lisp
15917
15918 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15919 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15920 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
15921 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15922 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15923 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15924 overrule the default with
15925
15926 @example
15927 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15928 @end example
15929
15930 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15931 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15932 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15933 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15934 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15935 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15936 a single line!):
15937
15938 @example
15939 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15940 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15941 @end example
15942
15943 @noindent
15944 Please check the documentation string of the function
15945 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15946 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15947 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15948 using the generic function.
15949
15950 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15951 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15952 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15953 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15954 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15955 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15956 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15957 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15958 others can benefit from your work.
15959
15960 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15961 @subsection Radio lists
15962 @cindex radio lists
15963 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15964
15965 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15966 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15967 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15968 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15969
15970 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15971
15972 @itemize @minus
15973 @item
15974 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15975 @item
15976 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15977 @item
15978 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15979 parameters.
15980 @item
15981 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15982 @end itemize
15983
15984 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15985 @LaTeX{} file:
15986
15987 @cindex #+ORGLST
15988 @example
15989 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15990 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15991 \begin@{comment@}
15992 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15993 - a new house
15994 - a new computer
15995 + a new keyboard
15996 + a new mouse
15997 - a new life
15998 \end@{comment@}
15999 @end example
16000
16001 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
16002 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16003
16004 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16005 @section Dynamic blocks
16006 @cindex dynamic blocks
16007
16008 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16009 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16010 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16011 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16012
16013 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16014 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16015 the content of the block.
16016
16017 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16018 @example
16019 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16020
16021 #+END:
16022 @end example
16023
16024 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16025
16026 @table @kbd
16027 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16028 Update dynamic block at point.
16029 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16030 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16031 @end table
16032
16033 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16034 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16035 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16036 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16037 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16038
16039 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16040 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16041 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16042 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16043 run:
16044
16045 @example
16046 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16047
16048 #+END:
16049 @end example
16050
16051 @noindent
16052 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16053
16054 @lisp
16055 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16056 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16057 (insert "Last block update at: "
16058 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16059 @end lisp
16060
16061 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16062 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16063 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16064 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16065 @code{org-mode}.
16066
16067 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16068 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16069
16070 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16071 @section Special agenda views
16072 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16073
16074 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16075 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16076 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16077 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16078 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16079 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16080 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16081 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16082 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16083 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16084 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16085
16086 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16087 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16088 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16089 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16090 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16091 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16092
16093 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16094 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16095 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16096 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16097 search should continue from there.
16098
16099 @lisp
16100 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16101 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16102 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16103 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16104 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16105 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16106 @end lisp
16107
16108 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16109 like this:
16110
16111 @lisp
16112 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16113 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16114 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16115 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16116 @end lisp
16117
16118 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16119 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16120 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16121
16122 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16123 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16124 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16125 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16126 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16127 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16128 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16129 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16130 you really want to have.
16131
16132 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16133 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16134 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16135
16136 @table @code
16137 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16138 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16139 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16140 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16141 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16142 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16143 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16144 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16145 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16146 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16147 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16148 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16149 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16150 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16151 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16152 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16153 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16154 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16155 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16156 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16157 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16158 @end table
16159
16160 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16161 like this, even without defining a special function:
16162
16163 @lisp
16164 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16165 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16166 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16167 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16168 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16169 @end lisp
16170
16171 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16172 @section Extracting agenda information
16173 @cindex agenda, pipe
16174 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16175
16176 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16177 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16178 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16179 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16180 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16181 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16182 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16183 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16184 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16185 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16186 current TODO list, you could use
16187
16188 @example
16189 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16190 @end example
16191
16192 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16193 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16194 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16195 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16196
16197 @example
16198 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16199 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16200 @end example
16201
16202 @noindent
16203 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16204
16205 @example
16206 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16207 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16208 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16209 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16210 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16211 | lpr
16212 @end example
16213
16214 @noindent
16215 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16216 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16217
16218 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16219 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16220 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16221 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16222 are:
16223
16224 @example
16225 category @r{The category of the item}
16226 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16227 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16228 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16229 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16230 diary @r{imported from diary}
16231 deadline @r{a deadline}
16232 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16233 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16234 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16235 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16236 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16237 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16238 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16239 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16240 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16241 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16242 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16243 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16244 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16245 @end example
16246
16247 @noindent
16248 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16249 led to the selection of the item.
16250
16251 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16252 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16253 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16254
16255 @example
16256 #!/usr/bin/perl
16257
16258 # define the Emacs command to run
16259 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16260
16261 # run it and capture the output
16262 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16263
16264 # loop over all lines
16265 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16266 # get the individual values
16267 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16268 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16269 # process and print
16270 print "[ ] $head\n";
16271 @}
16272 @end example
16273
16274 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16275 @section Using the property API
16276 @cindex API, for properties
16277 @cindex properties, API
16278
16279 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16280 properties.
16281
16282 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16283 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16284 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16285 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16286 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16287 if the property key was used several times.@*
16288 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16289 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16290 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16291 @end defun
16292 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16293 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16294 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16295 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16296 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16297 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16298 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16299 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16300 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16301 @end defun
16302
16303 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16304 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16305 @end defun
16306
16307 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16308 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16309 @end defun
16310
16311 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16312 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16313 @end defun
16314
16315 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16316 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16317 @end defun
16318
16319 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16320 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16321 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16322 @end defun
16323
16324 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16325 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16326 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16327 @end defun
16328
16329 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16330 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16331 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16332 @end defun
16333
16334 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16335 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16336 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16337 @end defun
16338
16339 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16340 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16341 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16342 @end defun
16343
16344 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16345 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16346 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16347 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16348 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16349 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16350 responsible for this property.
16351 @end defopt
16352
16353 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16354 @section Using the mapping API
16355 @cindex API, for mapping
16356 @cindex mapping entries, API
16357
16358 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16359 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16360 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16361 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16362 is:
16363
16364 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16365 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16366
16367 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16368 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16369 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16370 returned as a list.
16371
16372 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16373 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16374 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16375 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16376 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16377 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16378 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16379 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16380 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16381 position.
16382
16383 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16384 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16385 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16386 visited by the iteration.
16387
16388 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16389
16390 @example
16391 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16392 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16393 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16394 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16395 file-with-archives
16396 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16397 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16398 agenda-with-archives
16399 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16400 (file1 file2 ...)
16401 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16402 @end example
16403 @noindent
16404 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16405 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16406
16407 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16408 @example
16409 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16410 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16411 function or Lisp form
16412 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16413 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16414 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16415 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16416 @end example
16417 @end defun
16418
16419 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16420 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16421 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16422 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16423
16424 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16425 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16426 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16427 @end defun
16428
16429 @defun org-priority &optional action
16430 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16431 possible values for ACTION.
16432 @end defun
16433
16434 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16435 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16436 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16437 @end defun
16438
16439 @defun org-promote
16440 Promote the current entry.
16441 @end defun
16442
16443 @defun org-demote
16444 Demote the current entry.
16445 @end defun
16446
16447 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16448 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16449 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16450
16451 @lisp
16452 (org-map-entries
16453 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16454 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16455 @end lisp
16456
16457 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16458 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16459
16460 @lisp
16461 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16462 @end lisp
16463
16464 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16465 @appendix MobileOrg
16466 @cindex iPhone
16467 @cindex MobileOrg
16468
16469 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16470 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16471 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16472 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16473 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16474 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16475 Moreland. Android users should check out
16476 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16477 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16478 features.
16479
16480 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16481 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16482 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16483
16484 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16485 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16486 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16487 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16488 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16489 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16490 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16491
16492 @menu
16493 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16494 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16495 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16496 @end menu
16497
16498 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16499 @section Setting up the staging area
16500
16501 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16502 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16503 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16504 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16505 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16506 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16507 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16508 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16509 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16510 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16511 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16512
16513 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16514 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16515 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16516 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16517 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16518 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16519 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16520 Emacs about it:
16521
16522 @lisp
16523 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16524 @end lisp
16525
16526 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16527 and to read captured notes from there.
16528
16529 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16530 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16531
16532 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16533 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16534 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16535 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16536 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16537 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16538 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16539 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16540 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16541 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16542 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16543 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16544 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16545 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16546 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16547 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16548 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16549 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16550
16551 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16552 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16553
16554 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16555 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16556 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16557 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16558 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16559
16560 @enumerate
16561 @item
16562 Org moves all entries found in
16563 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16564 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16565 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16566 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16567 @item
16568 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16569 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16570 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16571 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16572 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16573 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16574 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16575 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16576 @item
16577 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16578 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16579 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16580 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16581 agenda line.
16582 @table @kbd
16583 @kindex ?
16584 @item ?
16585 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16586 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16587 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16588 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16589 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16590 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16591 this flagged entry is finished.
16592 @end table
16593 @end enumerate
16594
16595 @kindex C-c a ?
16596 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16597 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16598 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16599 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16600 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16601 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16602 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16603
16604 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16605 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16606 @cindex acknowledgments
16607 @cindex history
16608 @cindex thanks
16609
16610 @section From Carsten
16611
16612 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16613 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16614 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16615 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16616 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16617 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16618 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16619 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16620 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16621 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16622 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16623 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16624 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16625 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16626 functionality directly into a notes file.
16627
16628 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16629 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16630 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16631 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16632 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16633 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16634 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16635 let me know.
16636
16637 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16638
16639 @table @i
16640 @item Bastien Guerry
16641 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16642 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16643 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16644 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16645 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16646 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16647 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16648 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16649 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16650 programming and reproducible research.
16651 @item John Wiegley
16652 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16653 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16654 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16655 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16656 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16657 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16658 @item Sebastian Rose
16659 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16660 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16661 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16662 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16663 single-key navigation.
16664 @end table
16665
16666 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16667 let me know what I am missing here!
16668
16669 @section From Bastien
16670
16671 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16672 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16673 to Carsten's ones above.
16674
16675 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16676 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16677 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16678
16679 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16680 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16681 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16682 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16683 either of the code or the community:
16684
16685 @table @i
16686 @item Eric Schulte
16687 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16688 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16689
16690 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16691 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16692 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16693 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16694
16695 @item Jambunathan K
16696 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16697 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16698 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16699 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16700
16701 @item Achim Gratz
16702 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16703 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16704 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16705
16706 @item Nick Dokos
16707 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16708 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16709 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16710 @end table
16711
16712 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16713 fair when shortlisting a few of them -- but Org's history would not be
16714 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16715
16716 @section List of contributions
16717
16718 @itemize @bullet
16719
16720 @item
16721 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16722 @item
16723 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16724 @item
16725 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16726 Org mode website.
16727 @item
16728 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16729 @item
16730 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16731 @item
16732 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16733 @item
16734 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16735 @item
16736 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16737 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16738 @item
16739 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16740 specified time.
16741 @item
16742 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16743 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16744 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16745 @item
16746 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16747 @item
16748 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16749 @item
16750 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16751 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16752 them.
16753 @item
16754 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16755 @item
16756 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16757 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16758 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16759 @item
16760 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16761 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16762 @item
16763 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16764 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16765 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16766 @item
16767 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16768 HTML agendas.
16769 @item
16770 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16771 @item
16772 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16773 @item
16774 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16775 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16776 @item
16777 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16778 @item
16779 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16780 @item
16781 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16782 @item
16783 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16784 testing.
16785 @item
16786 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16787 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16788 @item
16789 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16790 @item
16791 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16792 @item
16793 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16794 @item
16795 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16796 book.
16797 @item
16798 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16799 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16800 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16801 @item
16802 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16803 patches.
16804 @item
16805 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16806 @item
16807 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16808 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16809 @item
16810 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16811 @item
16812 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16813 @item
16814 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16815 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16816 @item
16817 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16818 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16819 @item
16820 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16821 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16822 small fixes and patches.
16823 @item
16824 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16825 @item
16826 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16827 @item
16828 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16829 basis.
16830 @item
16831 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16832 happy.
16833 @item
16834 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16835 @item
16836 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16837 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16838 @item
16839 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16840 @item
16841 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16842 @item
16843 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16844 file links, and TAGS.
16845 @item
16846 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16847 version of the reference card.
16848 @item
16849 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16850 into Japanese.
16851 @item
16852 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16853 @item
16854 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16855 links, among other things.
16856 @item
16857 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16858 provided frequent feedback.
16859 @item
16860 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16861 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16862 @item
16863 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16864 @item
16865 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16866 control.
16867 @item
16868 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16869 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16870 @item
16871 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16872 @item
16873 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16874 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16875 @item
16876 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16877 extensive patches.
16878 @item
16879 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16880 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16881 @item
16882 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16883 other things.
16884 @item
16885 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16886 @item
16887 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16888 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16889 @item
16890 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16891 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16892 @item
16893 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16894 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16895 @item
16896 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16897 subtrees.
16898 @item
16899 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16900 @item
16901 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16902 tweaks and features.
16903 @item
16904 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16905 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16906 @item
16907 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16908 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16909 @item
16910 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16911 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16912 @item
16913 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16914 chapter about publishing.
16915 @item
16916 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16917 @item
16918 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16919 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16920 @item
16921 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16922 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16923 concept index for HTML export.
16924 @item
16925 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16926 in HTML output.
16927 @item
16928 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16929 @item
16930 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16931 keyword.
16932 @item
16933 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16934 system.
16935 @item
16936 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16937 linking to Gnus.
16938 @item
16939 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16940 work on a tty.
16941 @item
16942 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16943 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16944 @end itemize
16945
16946
16947 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16948 @unnumbered Concept index
16949
16950 @printindex cp
16951
16952 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16953 @unnumbered Key index
16954
16955 @printindex ky
16956
16957 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16958 @unnumbered Command and function index
16959
16960 @printindex fn
16961
16962 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16963 @unnumbered Variable index
16964
16965 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16966 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16967 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16968
16969 @printindex vr
16970
16971 @bye
16972
16973 @c Local variables:
16974 @c fill-column: 77
16975 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16976 @c paragraph-start: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16977 @c paragraph-separate: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16978 @c End:
16979
16980
16981 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre